blob: 583610f75f07839ad631e79799b473ce4afbd36b [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1f973062021-05-14 09:36:37 +02005 version 2.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau446344c2021-08-28 13:46:11 +02007 2021/08/28
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001028.2.4. HTTPS log format
1038.2.5. Custom log format
1048.2.6. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001058.3. Advanced logging options
1068.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1078.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1088.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1098.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1108.4. Timing events
1118.5. Session state at disconnection
1128.6. Non-printable characters
1138.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1148.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1158.9. Examples of logs
116
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001179. Supported filters
1189.1. Trace
1199.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001209.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001219.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001229.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001239.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200124
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012510. FastCGI applications
12610.1. Setup
12710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12810.1.2. Proxy section
12910.1.3. Example
13010.2. Default parameters
13110.3. Limitations
132
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013311. Address formats
13411.1. Address family prefixes
13511.2. Socket type prefixes
13611.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137
1381. Quick reminder about HTTP
139----------------------------
140
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100141When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
143on almost anything found in the contents.
144
145However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
146formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
147correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
148
149
1501.1. The HTTP transaction model
151-------------------------------
152
153The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100154to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100155from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
156connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157will involve a new connection :
158
159 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
160
161In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
162establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
163by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
164length.
165
166Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
167to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
168however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
169response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
170header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
171
172 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
173
174Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
175power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
176but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200177a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100179Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
181second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
182page :
183
184 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
185
186This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
187latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
188correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
189the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100190server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100192The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
193time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
194are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
195parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
196carry the stream identifier.
197
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
199connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
200leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100201start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
202processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
203waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200204
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200205HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100206 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
207 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100208 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100209 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200210 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100211
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213
2141.2. HTTP request
215-----------------
216
217First, let's consider this HTTP request :
218
219 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100220 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
222 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
223 3 User-agent: my small browser
224 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
225 5 Accept: image/png
226
227
2281.2.1. The Request line
229-----------------------
230
231Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
232
233 - a METHOD : GET
234 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
235 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
236
237All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
238which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
239followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
240is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
241desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
242the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
243
244The URI itself can have several forms :
245
246 - A "relative URI" :
247
248 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
249
250 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
251 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
252
253 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
254
255 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
256
257 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
258 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
259 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
260 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
261 must accept this form too.
262
263 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
264 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
265 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200267 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
268 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
269 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
270 other protocols too.
271
272In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
273mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
274on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
275It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
276specific to the language, framework or application in use.
277
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100278HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100279assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200281
2821.2.2. The request headers
283--------------------------
284
285The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
286beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
287an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
288Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
289values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
290encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
291the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
292define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100294Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100296"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200297as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
298normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
299representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
300HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301
302The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
303that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
304is one valid form of empty line.
305
306Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
307headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
308about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
309application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
310
311Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000312 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
314 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
315 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
316
317
3181.3. HTTP response
319------------------
320
321An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
322messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
323
324 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100325 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200326 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
327 2 Content-length: 350
328 3 Content-Type: text/html
329
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
331codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
332response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100333continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
334the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
335following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
336sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
337(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
338correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
339such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
340state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400341over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100342if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
343information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003461.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347------------------------
348
349Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
350
351 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
352 - a status code : 200
353 - a reason : OK
354
355The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100356 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
357 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
358 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
359 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
360 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000362Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100363"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
365messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
366or "Authentication Required".
367
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100368HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200369
370 Code When / reason
371 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
372 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100375 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
376 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377 400 for an invalid or too large request
378 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
379 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100381 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100383 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
384 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400385 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400387 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100388 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200389 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200390 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200391 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
392 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
393 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
394
395The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3964.2).
397
398
3991.3.2. The response headers
400---------------------------
401
402Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
403the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
404details.
405
406
4072. Configuring HAProxy
408----------------------
409
4102.1. Configuration file format
411------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200412
413HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
414
415 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100416 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700417 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100418 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200419
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100420The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
421a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100422
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100423 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
424
425 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
426
427 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
428 tab characters
429
430 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
431 keyword sequences listed in this document
432
433 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
434 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
435 parts of the configuration, or expressions
436
437 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
438 are supported
439
440 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
441 section
442
443This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
444generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
445figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
446
447First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
448the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
449a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
450word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
451follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
452the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
453the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
454the parts that need to be addressed.
455
456A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
457requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
458extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
459the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
460section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
461section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
462not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
463
464A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
465each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
466a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
467start a new one.
468
469Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
470that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
471applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
472"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
473processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
474ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
475which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
476In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
477of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
478identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
479such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4802, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
481
482 listen foo
483 bind :80
484
485 listen bar
486 bind :81
487
488Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
489spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
490of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
491following configurations are strictly equivalent:
492
493 global#this is the global section
494 daemon#daemonize
495 frontend foo
496 mode http # or tcp
497
498and:
499
500 global
501 daemon
502
503 # this is the public web frontend
504 frontend foo
505 mode http
506
507The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
508new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
509other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
510section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
511section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
512at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
513
514Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
515are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
516editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
517support automatic indent.
518
519In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
520positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
521modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
522anymore, and is not recommended.
523
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200524
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005252.2. Quoting and escaping
526-------------------------
527
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100528In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
529that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
530possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
531in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
532('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200533
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100534This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
535very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
536the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
537also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
538delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
539word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
540remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200541
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100542If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
543(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
544
545Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
546backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200547
548 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
549 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
550 \\ to use a backslash
551 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
552 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
553
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100554In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
555C-language representation:
556
557 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
558 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
559 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
560 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
561
562Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
563or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
564of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200565
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100566 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200567 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
568 # hash as a comment start
569
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100570Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
571evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
572dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
573backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200574
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100575Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
576character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
577is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200578
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100579As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
580entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
581name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
582represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
583hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200584
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100585 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
586 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
587 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
588 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
589 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
590 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
591 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
592 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
593 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
594 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
595 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200596
597 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100598 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200599 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
600 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
601 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
603 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
604
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100605There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
606necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
607by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
608they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
609escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
610characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
611case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
612if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
613own quotes.
614
615The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
616quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500617not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100618quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
619
620Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
621arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
622
623 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
624 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
625
626Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
627"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
628cannot write:
629
630 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
631
632because we would like the string to cut like this:
633
634 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
635 |---------|----|-|
636 arg1 _/ / /
637 arg2 __________/ /
638 arg3 ______________/
639
640but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
641parenthesis then garbage:
642
643 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
644 |--------|--------|
645 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
646 trailing garbage _________/
647
648The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
649quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
650processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
651this word:
652
653 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
654 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
655 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
656
657So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
658still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
659the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
660the second level:
661
662 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
663 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
664 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
665 |---------||----|-|
666 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
667 arg2=blah ___________/ /
668 arg3=g _______________/
669
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500670Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100671double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
672
673 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
674 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
675 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
676 |---------||----|-|
677 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
678 arg2 ___________/ /
679 arg3 _______________/
680
681When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
682appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
683string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
684thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
685
686 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
687 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
688 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
689 |-------------| |-----||-|
690 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
691 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
692 arg3 ______________________/
693
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400694Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100695that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
696quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
697single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
698level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
699
700When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
701double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
702and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
703a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
704a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
705the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
706regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
707around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
708more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200709
710
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007112.3. Environment variables
712--------------------------
713
714HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
715interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
716configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
717optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
718shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200719underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
720list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
721arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
722before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200723
724 Example:
725
726 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
727
728 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
729
730 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
731
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200732Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
733file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200734
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200735* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
736 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
737
738* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
739 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
740 directory.
741
742* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
743
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500744* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200745 processes, separated by semicolons.
746
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500747* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200748 CLI, separated by semicolons.
749
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200750In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
751regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
752only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
753
754* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
755
756* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
757 starting at one.
758
759* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
760 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
761 first section.
762
763These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
764if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
765section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
766"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
767proxies.
768
769This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
770logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
771to name some config objects like servers for example.
772
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200773See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200774
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100775
7762.4. Conditional blocks
777-----------------------
778
779It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
780some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
781ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
782configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
783versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
784preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
785text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
786lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
787switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
788are defined to form conditional blocks:
789
790 - .if <condition>
791 - .elif <condition>
792 - .else
793 - .endif
794
795The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
796as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
797matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
798there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
799only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
800".elif" of a block.
801
802Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
803ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
804as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
805
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200806Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
807See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
808
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200809The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
810expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100811
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100812 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
813 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200814 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200815 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Kunal Gangakhedkard0bacde2021-08-17 11:55:45 +0530816 - an exclamation mark ('!') preceding any of the non-empty elements above,
817 and which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200818 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
819 from left to right until one returns false
820 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
821 from right to left until one returns true
822
823Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
824operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200825
826The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
827
828 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
829 exists, regardless of its contents
830
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200831 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
832 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
833 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
834
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200835 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
836 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
837
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200838 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
839 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
840 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
841 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
842
843 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
844 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
845 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
846 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
847
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200848Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100849
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200850 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
851 listen mwcli_px
852 bind :1111
853 ...
854 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100855
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200856 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
857 bind :80
858 .endif
859
860 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200861 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200862 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200863 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200864 .endif
865
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200866 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200867 bind :443 ssl crt ...
868 .endif
869
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200870 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
871 profiling.memory on
872 .endif
873
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200874 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
875 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
876 .endif
877
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200878Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100879
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200880 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100881 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
882 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
883 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
884
885Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
886"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
887fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
888provide advice to the user.
889
890Example:
891
892 .if "${A}"
893 .if "${B}"
894 .notice "A=1, B=1"
895 .elif "${C}"
896 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
897 .elif "${D}"
898 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
899 .else
900 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
901 .endif
902 .else
903 .notice "A=0"
904 .endif
905
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200906 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
907 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
908
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100909
9102.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200911----------------
912
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100913Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100914values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
915otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
916numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
917for every keyword. Supported units are :
918
919 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
920 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
921 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
922 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
923 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
924 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
925
926
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009272.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200928-------------
929
930 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
931 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
932 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
933 global
934 daemon
935 maxconn 256
936
937 defaults
938 mode http
939 timeout connect 5000ms
940 timeout client 50000ms
941 timeout server 50000ms
942
943 frontend http-in
944 bind *:80
945 default_backend servers
946
947 backend servers
948 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
949
950
951 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
952 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
953 global
954 daemon
955 maxconn 256
956
957 defaults
958 mode http
959 timeout connect 5000ms
960 timeout client 50000ms
961 timeout server 50000ms
962
963 listen http-in
964 bind *:80
965 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
966
967
968Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
969
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100970 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200971
972
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009733. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200974--------------------
975
976Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
977are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
978of them have command-line equivalents.
979
980The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
981
982 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200983 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200984 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200985 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200986 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200987 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200988 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200989 - description
990 - deviceatlas-json-file
991 - deviceatlas-log-level
992 - deviceatlas-separator
993 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +0200994 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900995 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200996 - gid
997 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100998 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200999 - h1-case-adjust
1000 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001001 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001002 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001003 - issuers-chain-path
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001004 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001005 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001007 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001008 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001009 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001010 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001011 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001012 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001013 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001014 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001015 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001016 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001017 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001018 - presetenv
1019 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001020 - uid
1021 - ulimit-n
1022 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001023 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001024 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001025 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001026 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001027 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001028 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001029 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001030 - ssl-default-bind-options
1031 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001032 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001033 - ssl-default-server-options
1034 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001035 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001036 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001037 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001038 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001039 - 51degrees-data-file
1040 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001041 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001042 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001043 - wurfl-data-file
1044 - wurfl-information-list
1045 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001046 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001047 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001048
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001049 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001050 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001051 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001052 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001053 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001054 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001055 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001056 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001057 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001058 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001059 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001060 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001061 - noepoll
1062 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001063 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001064 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001065 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001066 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001067 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001068 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001069 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001070 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001071 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001072 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001073 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001074 - tune.buffers.limit
1075 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001076 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001077 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001078 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001079 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001080 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001081 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001082 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001083 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001084 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001085 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001086 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001087 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001088 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001089 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1090 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001091 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001092 - tune.maxaccept
1093 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001094 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001095 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001096 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001097 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1098 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001099 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1100 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001101 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001102 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001103 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001104 - tune.sndbuf.client
1105 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001106 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001107 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001108 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001109 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001110 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001111 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001112 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +02001113 - tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size
1114 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size (deprecated)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001115 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001116 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001117 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1118 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1119 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001120 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1121 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001122
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001123 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001124 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001125 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001126
1127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011283.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001129------------------------------------
1130
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001131ca-base <dir>
1132 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001133 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1134 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1135 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001136
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001137chroot <jail dir>
1138 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1139 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1140 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1141 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1142 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001143 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001144
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001145cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001146 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001147 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1148 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1149 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1150 set. These sets have the format
1151
1152 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1153
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001154 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
1155 word size. Any process IDs above 1 and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001156 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001157 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all thraeds at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001158 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1159 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001160 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1161 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1162 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1163 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1164 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1165 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1166 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1167 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1168 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1169 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001170
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001171 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1172 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1173 on the machine's word size.
1174
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001175 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001176 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing threads and
1177 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1178 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
1179 highest bound. Having both a process and a thread range with the "auto:"
1180 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1181 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001182
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001183 Note that process ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a
1184 lone number designates a process and must be 1, and specifying a thread range
1185 or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of it. Finally, "1" is strictly
1186 equivalent to "1/all" and designates all threads on the process.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001187
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001188 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001189 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1190 # first 4 CPUs
1191
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001192 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1193 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001194 # word size.
1195
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001196 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1197 # and so on.
1198 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1199 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1200 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1201
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001202 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1203 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1204 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1205 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001206
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001207 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1208 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1209 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001210
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001211crt-base <dir>
1212 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001213 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1214 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001215
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001216daemon
1217 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1218 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001219 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1220 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001221
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001222default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001223 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001224 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1225 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1226 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1227 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1228 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1229 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1230 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1231 not start with a slash ('/'):
1232 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1233 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1234
1235 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1236 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1237 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1238 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1239 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1240 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1241 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1242 each of them.
1243
1244 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1245 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1246 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1247 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1248 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1249 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1250 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1251 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1252
1253 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1254 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001255 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001256 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1257 made easily relocatable.
1258
1259 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1260 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1261 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1262 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1263 consistent across all configuration files.
1264
1265 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1266 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1267 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1268 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1269 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1270 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1271 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1272 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1273
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001274deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1275 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001276 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001277
1278deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001279 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001280 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1281
1282deviceatlas-separator <char>
1283 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1284 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1285
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001286deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001287 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1288 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1289 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001290
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001291expose-experimental-directives
1292 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1293 the config file will be rejected.
1294
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001295external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001296 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1297 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001298 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1299 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1300 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1301 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1302 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001303
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001304gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001305 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001306 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1307 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001308 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001309 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001310 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001311
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001312group <group name>
1313 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1314 See also "gid" and "user".
1315
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001316hard-stop-after <time>
1317 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1318
1319 Arguments :
1320 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1321 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1322 SIGUSR1 signal.
1323
1324 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1325 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1326 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1327
1328 Example:
1329 global
1330 hard-stop-after 30s
1331
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001332h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1333 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1334 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1335 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1336 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001337 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001338 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1339 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1340 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1341 specified in a proxy.
1342
1343 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1344 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1345 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1346 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1347 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1348 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1349 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1350
1351 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1352 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1353 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1354 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1355 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1356
1357 Example:
1358 global
1359 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1360
1361 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1362 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1363
1364h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1365 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1366 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1367 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1368 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1369 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1370 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1371 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1372 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1373
1374 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1375 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1376 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1377
1378 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1379 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1380
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001381insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001382 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001383 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1384 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1385 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1386 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1387 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1388 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1389 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001390 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001391 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1392 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1393 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1394 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1395 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1396 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1397 disable it.
1398
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001399insecure-setuid-wanted
1400 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1401 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1402 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1403 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001404 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001405 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001406 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001407 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1408 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001409 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001410 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1411 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1412 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1413 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1414
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001415issuers-chain-path <dir>
1416 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1417 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1418 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001419 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001420 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1421 "issuers-chain-path".
1422 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1423 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1424 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1425 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1426 will share the chain in memory.
1427
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001428h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1429 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1430 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1431 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1432 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1433 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1434 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1435 the keyword with "no'.
1436
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001437localpeer <name>
1438 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1439 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1440 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1441 the configuration parsing.
1442
1443 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1444 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1445
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001446log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001447 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001448 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001449 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001450 configured with "log global".
1451
1452 <address> can be one of:
1453
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001454 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001455 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1456 port).
1457
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001458 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1459 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1460 port).
1461
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001462 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001463 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1464 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001465 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001466
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001467 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1468 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1469 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1470 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1471 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1472 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1473 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1474 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1475 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1476 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001477 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001478 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1479 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1480 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001481 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1482 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001483
1484 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1485 "fd@2", see above.
1486
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001487 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1488 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1489 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1490 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1491 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1492
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001493 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1494 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001495
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001496 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1497 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1498 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1499 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1500 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1501 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1502 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1503 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1504 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1505 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001506 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1507 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001508
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001509 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1510 one of the following :
1511
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001512 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1513 field is stripped. This is the default.
1514 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1515 rfc3164.
1516
1517 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001518 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1519
1520 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1521 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1522
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001523 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1524 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1525 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1526 designed to be used with a local log server.
1527
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001528 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1529 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1530 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1531 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1532 logger consumes.
1533
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001534 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1535 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1536 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1537 used with a local log server.
1538
1539 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1540 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1541 designed to be used with a local log server.
1542
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001543 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1544 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1545 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1546 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1547
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001548 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1549 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1550 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1551 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1552 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1553
1554 <sample_size>
1555 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1556 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1557 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1558 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1559 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1560
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001561 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001562
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001563 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1564 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1565 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1566
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001567 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1568 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1569 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1570 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001571
1572 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001573 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1574 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1575 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1576 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1577 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1578 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001579
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001580 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001581
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001582log-send-hostname [<string>]
1583 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1584 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1585 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1586 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1587 the logs.
1588
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001589log-tag <string>
1590 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1591 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1592 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001593 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001594
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001595lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001596 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1597 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1598 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1599 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1600 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1601 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001602 used multiple times.
1603
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001604lua-load-per-thread <file>
1605 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1606 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1607 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1608 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1609 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1610 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1611 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1612 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1613 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1614 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1615 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1616 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1617 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1618 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1619 times.
1620
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001621lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1622 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1623 variable.
1624 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1625 to "path".
1626
1627 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1628 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1629 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1630 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1631 will be checked earlier.
1632
1633 As an example by specifying the following path:
1634
1635 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1636 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1637
1638 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1639 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1640 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1641 paths if that does not exist either.
1642
1643 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1644 documentation.
1645
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001646master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001647 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1648 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1649 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001650 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001651 or daemon mode.
1652
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001653 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1654 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1655 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1656 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1657 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001658
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001659 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001660
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001661mworker-max-reloads <number>
1662 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001663 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001664 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1665 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1666 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1667
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001668nbthread <number>
1669 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02001670 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
1671 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
1672 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
1673 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
1674 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
1675 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
1676 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001677
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001678numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001679 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001680 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1681 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1682 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1683 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1684 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1685 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1686 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1687 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1688
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001689pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001690 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1691 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1692 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1693 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001694
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001695pp2-never-send-local
1696 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1697 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1698 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1699 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1700 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1701 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1702 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1703 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1704 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1705 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1706 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1707
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001708presetenv <name> <value>
1709 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1710 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1711 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1712 and "unsetenv".
1713
1714resetenv [<name> ...]
1715 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1716 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1717 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1718 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1719 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1720 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1721 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1722 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1723
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001724stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001725 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some stats
1726 instances on certain processes only. The default and only accepted value is
1727 "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this setting.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001728
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001729server-state-base <directory>
1730 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001731 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1732 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001733
1734server-state-file <file>
1735 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1736 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1737 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1738 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1739 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1740 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1741 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1742 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001743 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1744 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001745
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001746set-var <var-name> <expr>
1747 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1748 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1749 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1750 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1751 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1752 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1753 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1754 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1755 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1756
1757 Example:
1758 global
1759 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1760 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1761 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1762
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001763setenv <name> <value>
1764 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1765 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1766 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1767 and "unsetenv".
1768
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001769set-dumpable
1770 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001771 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1772 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1773 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1774 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1775 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1776 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1777 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1778 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1779 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1780 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1781 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1782 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1783 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1784 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1785 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001786 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001787 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001788
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001789ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1790 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1791 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001792 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001793 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001794 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1795 information and recommendations see e.g.
1796 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1797 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1798 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1799 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001800
1801ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1802 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1803 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1804 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1805 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1806 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001807 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1808 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1809 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001810 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001811
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001812ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1813 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1814 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1815 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1816 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1817 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1818
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001819ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1820 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1821 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1822 keyword to see available options.
1823
1824 Example:
1825 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001826 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001827
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001828ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1829 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1830 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001831 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001832 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001833 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1834 information and recommendations see e.g.
1835 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1836 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1837 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1838 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1839 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001840
1841ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1842 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1843 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1844 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1845 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1846 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001847 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1848 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1849 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1850 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001851
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001852ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1853 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1854 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1855 keyword to see available options.
1856
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001857ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1858 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1859 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1860 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001861 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001862 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001863 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1864 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1865 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1866 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001867 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1868 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1869 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1870
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001871ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1872 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1873 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001874 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001875 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001876 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1877
1878 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001879
1880 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1881 and won't try to remove them.
1882
1883 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1884
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001885ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001886 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001887 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1888 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1889 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001890
1891 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1892 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1893 optimize the startup time.
1894
1895 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1896 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1897 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1898
1899 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001900 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001901
1902 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001903 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1904 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001905
1906 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1907 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1908 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1909 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1910 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001911 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001912
1913 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001914 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001915 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1916 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1917 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1918 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1919 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001920 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001921
1922 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1923
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001924 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001925 a cert bundle.
1926
1927 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1928 separately in several "crt".
1929
1930 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1931 since files are loading separately.
1932
1933 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1934 required to commit them.
1935
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001936 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001937 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001938
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001939 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1940 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1941 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001942
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001943 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1944 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1945 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001946
1947 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001948 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
1949 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001950
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001951 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1952 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1953
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001954 The default behavior is "all".
1955
1956 Example:
1957 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1958 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1959 ssl-load-extra-files none
1960
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001961 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
1962 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001963
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001964ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1965 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1966 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1967 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1968
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001969ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001970 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001971 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1972 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1973 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1974 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1975 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1976 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001977 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001978
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001979stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1980 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1981 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1982 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001983 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001984 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001985
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001986 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1987 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1988 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001989
1990stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1991 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1992 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001993 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001994
1995stats maxconn <connections>
1996 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1997 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1998
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001999uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002000 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002001 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2002 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2003 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2004
2005ulimit-n <number>
2006 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2007 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2008 option.
2009
Amaury Denoyelle414a6122021-08-06 10:25:32 +02002010 Note that the dynamic servers are not taken into account in this automatic
2011 resource calculation. If using a large number of them, it may be needed to
2012 manually specify this value.
2013
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002014unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2015 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2016
2017 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2018 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2019 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2020 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2021 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002022 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002023 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2024 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2025 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2026 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2027
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002028unsetenv [<name> ...]
2029 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2030 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2031 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2032 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2033 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2034 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2035 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2036
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002037user <user name>
2038 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2039 See also "uid" and "group".
2040
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002041node <name>
2042 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2043
2044 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2045 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2046 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2047 traffic.
2048
2049description <text>
2050 Add a text that describes the instance.
2051
2052 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2053 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2054 "<" and ">" characters.
2055
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100205651degrees-data-file <file path>
2057 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002058 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002059
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002060 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002061 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2062
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000206351degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002064 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2065 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2066 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2067
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002068 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002069 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2070
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200207151degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002072 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2073 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2074
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002075 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002076 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2077
207851degrees-cache-size <number>
2079 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2080 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2081 By default, this cache is disabled.
2082
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002083 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002084 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2085
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002086wurfl-data-file <file path>
2087 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2088 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2089
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002090 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002091 with USE_WURFL=1.
2092
2093wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2094 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2095 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2096 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2097
2098 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2099
2100 Valid WURFL properties are:
2101 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2102
2103 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2104 device.
2105
2106 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2107 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2108
2109 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2110 particular web request.
2111
2112 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2113 used Libwurfl API version.
2114
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002115 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2116 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2117
2118 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2119 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2120
2121 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2122
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002123 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002124 with USE_WURFL=1.
2125
2126wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2127 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2128 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2129
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002130 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002131 with USE_WURFL=1.
2132
2133wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2134 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2135 thus before the chroot.
2136
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002137 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002138 with USE_WURFL=1.
2139
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002140wurfl-cache-size <size>
2141 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2142 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002143 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002144 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002145
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002146 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002147 with USE_WURFL=1.
2148
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002149strict-limits
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002150 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002151 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2152 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002153 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002154 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002155
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021563.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002157-----------------------
2158
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002159busy-polling
2160 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2161 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2162 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2163 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2164 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2165 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2166 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2167 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2168 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2169 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2170 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2171 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2172 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2173 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2174 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2175 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2176 "poll" pollers.
2177
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002178 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2179 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2180 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2181
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002182max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002183 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002184 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2185 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2186 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2187 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2188 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2189 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2190 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2191
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002192maxconn <number>
2193 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2194 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2195 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002196 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2197 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2198 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2199 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002200 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2201 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2202 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2203 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2204 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2205 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002206
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002207maxconnrate <number>
2208 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2209 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2210 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2211 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2212 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2213 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2214 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2215 fairness.
2216
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002217maxcomprate <number>
2218 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002219 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002220 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2221 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2222 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002223 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002224 default value.
2225
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002226maxcompcpuusage <number>
2227 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2228 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2229 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002230 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2231 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2232 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2233 and from introducing high latencies.
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002234
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002235maxpipes <number>
2236 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2237 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2238 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2239 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2240 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2241 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2242
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002243maxsessrate <number>
2244 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2245 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2246 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2247 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2248 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2249 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2250 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2251 fairness.
2252
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002253maxsslconn <number>
2254 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2255 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2256 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2257 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2258 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2259 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2260 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002261 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2262 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2263 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2264 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002265 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002266 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2267 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002268
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002269maxsslrate <number>
2270 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2271 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2272 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2273 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2274 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2275 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2276 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2277 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2278 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2279 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2280
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002281maxzlibmem <number>
2282 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2283 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2284 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002285 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2286 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2287 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2288
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002289noepoll
2290 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2291 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002292 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002293
2294nokqueue
2295 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2296 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2297 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2298
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002299noevports
2300 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2301 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2302 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2303 also "nopoll".
2304
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002305nopoll
2306 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2307 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002308 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002309 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2310 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002311
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002312nosplice
2313 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002314 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002315 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002316 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002317 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2318 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2319 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2320 "option splice-response".
2321
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002322nogetaddrinfo
2323 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2324 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2325
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002326noreuseport
2327 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2328 command line argument "-dR".
2329
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002330profiling.memory { on | off }
2331 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2332 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2333 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2334 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2335 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2336 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2337 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2338 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2339 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2340
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002341profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2342 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2343 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2344 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2345 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002346 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002347 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2348 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2349 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2350 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2351
2352 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2353 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2354 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2355 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2356 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002357 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2358 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2359 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2360 CLI.
2361
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002362spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002363 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2364 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2365 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2366 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2367 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2368 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002369
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002370ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002371 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002372 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002373 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002374 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002375 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2376 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2377 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002378 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2379 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002380 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2381 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2382 openssl configuration file uses:
2383 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2384
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002385ssl-mode-async
2386 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002387 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002388 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2389 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002390 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002391 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002392 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002393
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002394tune.buffers.limit <number>
2395 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2396 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2397 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2398 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2399 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002400 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002401 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2402 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2403 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2404 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2405 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2406 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2407 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2408 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002409 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002410
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002411tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2412 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2413 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2414 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002415 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002416
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002417tune.bufsize <number>
2418 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2419 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2420 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2421 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2422 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2423 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2424 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002425 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2426 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002427 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002428 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002429 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002430 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2431 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002432
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002433tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2434 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2435 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2436 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2437 this value. The default value is 1.
2438
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002439tune.fail-alloc
2440 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2441 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2442 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2443 gracefully.
2444
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002445tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2446 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2447 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2448 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2449 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2450 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2451
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002452tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2453 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2454 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2455 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2456 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2457 change it.
2458
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002459tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2460 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002461 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002462 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002463 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2464 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2465 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2466 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2467 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2468
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002469tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2470 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2471 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2472 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2473 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2474 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002475 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002476 recommended not to change this value.
2477
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002478tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002479 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002480 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002481 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002482 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2483 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2484 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2485 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2486
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002487tune.http.cookielen <number>
2488 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2489 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2490 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2491 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2492 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2493 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2494 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2495 to change this value.
2496
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002497tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002498 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2499 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002500 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002501 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002502 configuration directives too.
2503 The default value is 1024.
2504
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002505tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2506 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2507 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2508 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2509 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2510 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2511 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002512 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2513 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2514 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002515
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002516tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2517 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2518 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2519 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2520 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2521 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2522 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002523 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2524 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2525 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2526 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2527 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002528
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002529tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002530 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002531 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2532 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2533 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2534 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002535 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002536 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002537 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002538 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2539
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002540tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2541 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2542 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2543 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2544 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2545 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2546 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2547 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2548 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2549 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2550
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002551tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2552 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002553 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002554 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2555 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002556 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002557 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2558 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2559
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002560tune.lua.maxmem
2561 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2562 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2563 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2564 memory.
2565
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002566tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2567 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002568 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2569 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002570 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002571
2572tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2573 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2574 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2575 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2576 check servers.
2577
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002578tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2579 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2580 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2581 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002582 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002583
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002584tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002585 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2586 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002587 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2588 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2589 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2590 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2591 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2592 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2593 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2594 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2595 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002596
2597tune.maxpollevents <number>
2598 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2599 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2600 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2601 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2602 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2603
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002604tune.maxrewrite <number>
2605 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2606 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2607 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2608 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2609 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2610 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2611 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2612 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2613 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2614 bufsize.
2615
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002616tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2617 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2618 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2619 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2620 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2621 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2622 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2623 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2624 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2625 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002626 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2627 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002628 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2629 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2630 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2631 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2632 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2633 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2634 setting this parameter to 0.
2635
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002636tune.pipesize <number>
2637 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2638 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2639 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2640 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2641 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2642 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2643
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002644tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2645 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002646 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002647 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2648 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2649 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2650 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002651 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002652
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002653tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2654 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002655 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002656 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2657 default is 20.
2658
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002659tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2660tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2661 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2662 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2663 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002664 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002665 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002666 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2667 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2668
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002669tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002670 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002671 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2672 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2673 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2674 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2675
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002676tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002677 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002678 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2679 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2680 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2681 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2682 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2683 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2684 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002685
2686tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2687 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002688 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002689 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2690 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2691 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2692 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2693 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2694 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2695 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002696
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002697tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2698tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2699 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2700 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2701 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002702 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002703 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002704 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2705 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2706 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2707 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002708 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002709
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002710tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002711 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002712 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2713 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2714 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2715 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2716 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2717 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2718 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2719 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2720 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002721 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
2722 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002723
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002724tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002725 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002726 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2727 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2728 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2729 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2730 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2731
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002732tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2733 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2734 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2735 performances. This is disabled by default.
2736
2737 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2738 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2739
2740 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2741
2742 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2743
2744 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2745
2746 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2747 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2748 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2749
2750 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2751 converted.
2752
2753 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2754 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2755 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2756 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2757 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2758 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2759 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002760 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2761 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002762
2763 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2764
2765 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2766 only need this line:
2767
2768 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2769
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002770tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2771 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002772 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002773 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2774 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2775 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2776 being used for too long.
2777
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002778tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2779 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2780 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2781 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2782 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2783 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2784 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2785 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2786 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2787 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2788 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002789 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002790 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002791
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002792tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2793 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2794 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2795 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2796 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002797 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002798 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2799 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002800 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2801 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002802
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002803tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2804 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2805 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2806 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2807 1000 entries.
2808
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +02002809tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size <number>
2810tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number> (deprecated)
Marcin Deranek769fd2e2021-07-12 14:16:55 +02002811 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
2812 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
2813 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
2814 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002815
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002816tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002817tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002818tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2819tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2820tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002821 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2822 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2823 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2824 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2825 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2826 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2827 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2828 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002829
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002830 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2831 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2832 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2833 all available space is consumed.
2834 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2835 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2836 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002837
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002838tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2839 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002840 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002841 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002842 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002843 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2844
2845tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2846 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2847 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002848 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2849 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002850
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028513.3. Debugging
2852--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002853
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002854quiet
2855 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2856 line argument "-q".
2857
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002858zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002859 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002860 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2861 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2862 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2863 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2864 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2865
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002866
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010028673.4. Userlists
2868--------------
2869It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2870http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2871it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2872
2873userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002874 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002875 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2876
2877group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002878 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002879 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2880 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2881
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002882user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2883 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002884 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2885 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002886 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2887 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2888 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2889 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002890
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002891 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2892 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2893 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2894 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2895 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2896 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2897 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002898 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002899 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002900
2901 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002902 userlist L1
2903 group G1 users tiger,scott
2904 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002905
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002906 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2907 user scott insecure-password elgato
2908 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002909
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002910 userlist L2
2911 group G1
2912 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002913
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002914 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2915 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2916 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002917
2918 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002919
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002920
29213.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002922----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002923It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002924several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002925instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2926values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2927automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2928In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2929using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2930tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2931reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2932Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2933that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2934each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002935
2936peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002937 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002938 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2939
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002940bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2941 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2942 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2943
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002944disabled
2945 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2946 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2947 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2948
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002949default-bind [param*]
2950 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2951
2952default-server [param*]
2953 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2954
2955 Arguments:
2956 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2957 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2958 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2959 details.
2960
2961
2962 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2963
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002964enable
2965 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2966
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002967log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002968 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2969 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2970 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2971 more details.
2972
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002973peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002974 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2975 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002976 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002977 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002978 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2979 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2980 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002981
2982 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2983 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2984
2985 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002986 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2987 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2988 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002989
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002990 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2991 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002992
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002993 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2994 "server" keyword explanation below).
2995
2996server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002997 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002998 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2999 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
3000 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
3001 of this "peers" section).
3002 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
3003
3004
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003005 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003006 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003007 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003008 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3009 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3010 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003011
3012 backend mybackend
3013 mode tcp
3014 balance roundrobin
3015 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3016 stick on src
3017
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003018 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3019 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003020
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003021 Example:
3022 peers mypeers
3023 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3024 default-server ssl verify none
3025 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
3026 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003027
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003028
3029table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3030 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3031
3032 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3033 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003034 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003035 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3036 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3037 "stick-table" keyword).
3038
3039 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3040 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3041 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3042 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3043 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3044 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3045 of the stick-table name as follows:
3046
3047 peers mypeers
3048 peer A ...
3049 peer B ...
3050 table t1 ...
3051
3052 frontend fe1
3053 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3054
3055 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3056 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3057
3058 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3059 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3060 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3061 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3062 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3063 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3064 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3065
3066 peers mypeers
3067 peer A ...
3068 peer B ...
3069 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3070
3071 backend t1
3072 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3073
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003074 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003075 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3076 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3077
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090030783.6. Mailers
3079------------
3080It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3081If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3082in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3083
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003084mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003085 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3086 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3087
3088mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3089 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3090
3091 Example:
3092 mailers mymailers
3093 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3094 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3095
3096 backend mybackend
3097 mode tcp
3098 balance roundrobin
3099
3100 email-alert mailers mymailers
3101 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3102 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3103
3104 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3105 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3106
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003107timeout mail <time>
3108 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3109 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3110 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3111 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3112
3113 Example:
3114 mailers mymailers
3115 timeout mail 20s
3116 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003117
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031183.7. Programs
3119-------------
3120In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3121master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3122managed the same way as the workers.
3123
3124During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3125sequence as a worker:
3126
3127 - the master is re-executed
3128 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3129 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3130 instance of the program
3131
3132During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3133
3134program <name>
3135 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3136 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3137 the management guide).
3138
3139command <command> [arguments*]
3140 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3141 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3142 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3143 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3144
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003145user <user name>
3146 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3147 See also "group".
3148
3149group <group name>
3150 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3151 See also "user".
3152
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003153option start-on-reload
3154no option start-on-reload
3155 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3156 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3157 program section.
3158
3159
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010031603.8. HTTP-errors
3161----------------
3162
3163It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3164imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3165several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3166
3167http-errors <name>
3168 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3169 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3170
3171errorfile <code> <file>
3172 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3173
3174 Arguments :
3175 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003176 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003177 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003178
3179 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3180 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3181 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3182 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3183 before any chroot is performed.
3184
3185 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3186
3187 Example:
3188 http-errors website-1
3189 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3190 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3191 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3192
3193 http-errors website-2
3194 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3195 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3196 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3197
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020031983.9. Rings
3199----------
3200
3201It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3202servers or traces.
3203
3204ring <ringname>
3205 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3206
3207description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003208 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003209 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3210
3211format <format>
3212 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3213
3214 Arguments:
3215 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3216 one of the following :
3217
3218 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3219 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3220 designed to be used with a local log server.
3221
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003222 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3223 field is stripped. This is the default.
3224 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3225 rfc3164.
3226
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003227 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3228 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3229 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3230 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3231 is the default.
3232
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003233 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003234 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3235
3236 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3237 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3238
3239 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3240 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3241 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3242 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3243 logger consumes.
3244
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003245 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3246 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3247 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3248 with a local log server.
3249
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003250 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3251 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3252 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3253 used with a local log server.
3254
3255maxlen <length>
3256 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3257 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3258 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3259
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003260server <name> <address> [param*]
3261 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3262 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3263 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3264 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3265 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3266 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3267 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3268 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3269 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003270 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3271 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003272
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003273size <size>
3274 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3275 set to BUFSIZE.
3276
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003277timeout connect <timeout>
3278 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3279
3280 Arguments :
3281 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3282 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3283 as explained at the top of this document.
3284
3285timeout server <timeout>
3286 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3287
3288 Arguments :
3289 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3290 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3291 as explained at the top of this document.
3292
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003293 Example:
3294 global
3295 log ring@myring local7
3296
3297 ring myring
3298 description "My local buffer"
3299 format rfc3164
3300 maxlen 1200
3301 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003302 timeout connect 5s
3303 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003304 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003305
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020033063.10. Log forwarding
3307-------------------
3308
3309It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003310HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003311
3312log-forward <name>
3313 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3314
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003315backlog <conns>
3316 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3317 on connections accept.
3318
3319bind <addr> [param*]
3320 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003321 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3322 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3323 syslog protocol over TCP.
3324 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003325 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3326
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003327dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003328 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3329 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3330 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3331 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003332 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003333
3334log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003335log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003336 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3337 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3338 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003339 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003340 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3341 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3342 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003343 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003344
3345 Example:
3346 global
3347 log stderr format iso local7
3348
3349 ring myring
3350 description "My local buffer"
3351 format rfc5424
3352 maxlen 1200
3353 size 32764
3354 timeout connect 5s
3355 timeout server 10s
3356 # syslog tcp server
3357 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3358
3359 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003360 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3361 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003362 # all messages on stderr
3363 log global
3364 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3365 log ring@myring local0
3366 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3367 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3368 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3369 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3370 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003371
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003372maxconn <conns>
3373 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3374 10 is the default.
3375
3376timeout client <timeout>
3377 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3378
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033794. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003380----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003381
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003382Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003383 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3384 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3385 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3386 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003387
3388A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3389connections.
3390
3391A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3392to forward incoming connections.
3393
3394A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3395parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3396
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003397A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3398ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3399sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3400the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3401explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3402from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3403"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3404for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3405to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3406optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3407are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3408any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3409names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3410that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3411duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3412names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3413
3414Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3415settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3416of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3417profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3418timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3419
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003420All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3421'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3422case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3423
3424Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3425logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3426proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3427However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3428name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3429
3430Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3431and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003432bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003433protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3434modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3435arbitrary criteria.
3436
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003437In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3438a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003439the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003440
3441 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3442 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3443 between responses and new requests.
3444
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003445 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3446 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3447 client-facing connection remains open.
3448
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003449 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3450 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003451
3452The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3453frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3454following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003455weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003456
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003457 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003458
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003459 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3460 ----+-----+-----+----
3461 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3462 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003463 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3464 ----+-----+-----+----
3465 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003466
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003467It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003468only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3469within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003470as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003471content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003472and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3473possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003474
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003475There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003476first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003477processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003478second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003479protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3480is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3481new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003482to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003483process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3484already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3485HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3486evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3487one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3488
3489There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3490performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3491tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3492preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3493analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3494HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3495header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3496mitigate this drawback.
3497
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003498There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003499method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3500set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3501in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3502is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3503to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3504above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3505to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3506"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3507frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3508frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3509as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3510upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3511on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3512the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3513upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3514frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3515remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003516
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035174.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3518--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003519
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003520The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3521limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3522they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3523limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003524marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003525option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003526and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3527with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3528specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003529
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003530
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003531 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3532------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3533acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003534backlog X X X -
3535balance X - X X
3536bind - X X -
3537bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003538capture cookie - X X -
3539capture request header - X X -
3540capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003541clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3542clitcpka-idle X X X -
3543clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003544compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003545cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003546declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003547default-server X - X X
3548default_backend X X X -
3549description - X X X
3550disabled X X X X
3551dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003552email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003553email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003554email-alert mailers X X X X
3555email-alert myhostname X X X X
3556email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003557enabled X X X X
3558errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003559errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003560errorloc X X X X
3561errorloc302 X X X X
3562-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3563errorloc303 X X X X
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02003564error-log-format X X X -
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003565force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003566filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003567fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003568hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003569http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003570http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003571http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003572http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003573http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003574http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003575http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003576http-check set-var X - X X
3577http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003578http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003579http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003580http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003581http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003582http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003583id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003584ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003585load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003586log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003587log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003588log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003589log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003590max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003591maxconn X X X -
3592mode X X X X
3593monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003594monitor-uri X X X -
3595option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3596option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3597option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3598option allbackups (*) X - X X
3599option checkcache (*) X - X X
3600option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3601option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003602option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003603option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3604option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003605-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3606option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003607option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3608option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003609option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003610option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003611option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003612option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003613option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003614option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3615option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3616option httpchk X - X X
3617option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003618option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02003619option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003620option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003621option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003622option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003623option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3624option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3625option logasap (*) X X X -
3626option mysql-check X - X X
3627option nolinger (*) X X X X
3628option originalto X X X X
3629option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003630option pgsql-check X - X X
3631option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003632option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003633option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003634option smtpchk X - X X
3635option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3636option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3637option splice-request (*) X X X X
3638option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003639option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003640option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3641option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3642-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003643option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003644option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3645option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3646option tcpka X X X X
3647option tcplog X X X X
3648option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003649external-check command X - X X
3650external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003651persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3652rate-limit sessions X X X -
3653redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003654-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003655retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003656retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003657server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003658server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003659server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003660source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003661srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3662srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3663srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003664stats admin - X X X
3665stats auth X X X X
3666stats enable X X X X
3667stats hide-version X X X X
3668stats http-request - X X X
3669stats realm X X X X
3670stats refresh X X X X
3671stats scope X X X X
3672stats show-desc X X X X
3673stats show-legends X X X X
3674stats show-node X X X X
3675stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003676-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3677stick match - - X X
3678stick on - - X X
3679stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003680stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003681stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003682tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003683tcp-check connect X - X X
3684tcp-check expect X - X X
3685tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003686tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003687tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003688tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003689tcp-check set-var X - X X
3690tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003691tcp-request connection - X X -
3692tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003693tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003694tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003695tcp-response content - - X X
3696tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003697timeout check X - X X
3698timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003699timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003700timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003701timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3702timeout http-request X X X X
3703timeout queue X - X X
3704timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003705timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003706timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003707timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003708transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003709unique-id-format X X X -
3710unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003711use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003712use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003713use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003714------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3715 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003716
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003717
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037184.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3719---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003720
3721This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3722
3723
3724acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3725 Declare or complete an access list.
3726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3727 no | yes | yes | yes
3728 Example:
3729 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3730 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3731 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3732
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003733 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003734
3735
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003736backlog <conns>
3737 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3739 yes | yes | yes | no
3740 Arguments :
3741 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3742 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003743 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003744
3745 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3746 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3747 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3748 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3749 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3750 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3751 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3752 backlog parameter.
3753
3754 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3755 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3756 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3757
3758 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3759
3760
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003761balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003762balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003763 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3765 yes | no | yes | yes
3766 Arguments :
3767 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3768 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3769 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3770 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3771
3772 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3773 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3774 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3775 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003776 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003777 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003778 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3779 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3780 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3781 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3782 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3783 it, so that you don't worry.
3784
3785 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3786 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3787 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3788 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3789 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3790 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3791 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3792 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003793
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003794 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3795 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3796 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3797 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3798 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3799 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3800 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003801 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3802 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3803 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003804
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003805 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003806 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003807 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3808 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003809 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003810 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3811 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3812 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3813 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3814 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003815 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3816 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3817 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3818 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3819 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3820 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003821
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003822 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3823 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3824 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3825 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3826 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3827 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3828 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3829 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003830 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003831 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003832 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3833 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3834 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003835
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003836 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3837 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3838 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3839 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3840 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3841 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3842 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3843 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3844 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3845 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3846 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3847 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003848
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003849 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003850 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3851 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3852 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3853 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3854 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3855 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3856 URIs start with a leading "/".
3857
3858 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3859 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3860 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3861 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3862
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003863 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3864 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3865 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3866 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3867
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003868 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003869 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3870
3871 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003872 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3873 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003874 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3875 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3876 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3877 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003878 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003879 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3880 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003881
3882 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3883 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3884 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3885 server will receive the request.
3886
3887 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3888 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3889 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3890 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3891 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003892 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3893 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3894 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003895
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003896 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3897 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3898 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3899 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3900 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003901
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003902 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003903 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3904 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3905 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3906
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003907 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3908 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3909 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3910
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003911 random
3912 random(<draws>)
3913 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003914 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3915 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3916 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3917 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003918 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3919 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3920 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3921 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3922 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3923 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3924 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3925 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3926 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3927 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3928 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3929 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3930 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3931 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3932 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3933 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3934 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3935 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3936 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3937 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003938
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003939 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003940 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003941 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3942 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3943 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3944 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3945 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3946 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003947 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003948 used instead.
3949
3950 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3951 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3952 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3953 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3954
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003955 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3956 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3957 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3958
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003959 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003960
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003961 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003962 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3963 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003964
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003965 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3966 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3967 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003968
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003969 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003970 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003971 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3972 NTLM relies on.
3973
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003974 Examples :
3975 balance roundrobin
3976 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003977 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003978 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3979 balance hdr(host)
3980 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003981
3982 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3983 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3984
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003985 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003986 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3987 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3988 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003989 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003990
3991 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3992 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3993 defaults to 16 kB.
3994
3995 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3996 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3997
3998 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3999 Round Robin.
4000
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004001 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004002 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4003 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4004 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4005
4006 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4007
4008 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004009 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004010 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4011 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4012 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004013
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02004014 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004015
4016
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004017bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4018bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004019 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4021 no | yes | yes | no
4022 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004023 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4024 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4025 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4026 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004027 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004028 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4029 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4030 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4031 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4032 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4033 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004034 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004035 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4036 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004037 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004038 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4039 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004040 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004041 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4042 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004043 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004044 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004045 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4046 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4047 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004048 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4049 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4050 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4051 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004052 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4053 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4054 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004055
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004056 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4057 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004058 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4059 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4060 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004061 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4062 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4063 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4064 the range.
4065
4066 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4067 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4068 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4069 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4070 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4071 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4072 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004073 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004074 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004075
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004076 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004077 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004078 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4079 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4080 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4081 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4082 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4083 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4084
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004085 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4086 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4087 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4088 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004089
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004090 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4091 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4092 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4093 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4094 in a frontend.
4095
4096 Example :
4097 listen http_proxy
4098 bind :80,:443
4099 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004100 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004101
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004102 listen http_https_proxy
4103 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004104 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004105
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004106 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4107 bind ipv6@:80
4108 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4109 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4110
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004111 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004112 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004113
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004114 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4115 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4116 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4117 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4118 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4119
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004120 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004121 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004122
4123
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004124bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4126 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004127
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02004128 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some
4129 frontends on certain processes only, or to adjust backends so that they
4130 could match the frontends that used them. The default and only accepted
4131 value is "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this
4132 setting. Threads can still be bound per-socket using the "process" bind
4133 keyword.
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004134
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02004135 See also : "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004136
4137
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004138capture cookie <name> len <length>
4139 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4141 no | yes | yes | no
4142 Arguments :
4143 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4144 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4145 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4146 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004147 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004148
4149 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4150 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4151 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4152 right if it exceeds <length>.
4153
4154 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4155 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4156 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4157 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4158
4159 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4160 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4161 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4162
4163 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4164 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4165 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004166 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4167 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4168 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004169
4170 Example:
4171 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4172
4173 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004174 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004175
4176
4177capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004178 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4180 no | yes | yes | no
4181 Arguments :
4182 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004183 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004184 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4185 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4186 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4187
4188 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4189 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4190 it exceeds <length>.
4191
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004192 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004193 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4194 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004195 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4196 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4197 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4198 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004199 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004200 environments to find where the request came from.
4201
4202 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4203 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4204 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4205 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004206
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004207 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4208 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4209 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4210 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4211 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004212
4213 Example:
4214 capture request header Host len 15
4215 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004216 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004218 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004219 about logging.
4220
4221
4222capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004223 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4225 no | yes | yes | no
4226 Arguments :
4227 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004228 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004229 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4230 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4231 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4232
4233 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4234 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4235 it exceeds <length>.
4236
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004237 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004238 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4239 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4240 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004241 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4242 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4243 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4244 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004245
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004246 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4247 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4248 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4249 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4250 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004251
4252 Example:
4253 capture response header Content-length len 9
4254 capture response header Location len 15
4255
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004256 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004257 about logging.
4258
4259
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004260clitcpka-cnt <count>
4261 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4262 the connection on the client side.
4263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4264 yes | yes | yes | no
4265 Arguments :
4266 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4267
4268 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4269 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004270 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4271 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004272
4273 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4274
4275
4276clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4277 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4278 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4279 client side.
4280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4281 yes | yes | yes | no
4282 Arguments :
4283 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4284 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4285 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4286 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4287
4288 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4289 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004290 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4291 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004292
4293 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4294
4295
4296clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4297 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4299 yes | yes | yes | no
4300 Arguments :
4301 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4302 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4303 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4304 document.
4305
4306 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4307 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004308 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4309 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004310
4311 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4312
4313
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004314compression algo <algorithm> ...
4315compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004316compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004317 Enable HTTP compression.
4318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4319 yes | yes | yes | yes
4320 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004321 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4322 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004323 offload makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004324
4325 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004326 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4327 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4328 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004329
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004330 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004331 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004332
4333 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4334 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4335 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4336 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4337 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004338 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004339
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004340 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4341 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4342 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4343 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4344 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4345 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4346 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004347 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004348
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004349 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004350 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004351 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004352 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004353 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004354 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004355 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004356
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004357 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004358 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4359 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004360 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4361 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004362 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004363 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004364 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4365 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004366 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004367 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4368 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004369
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004370 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004371 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4372 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004373 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004374 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004375 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4376 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4377 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4378 "multipart"
4379 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4380 header
4381 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4382 and later
4383 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4384 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004385 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004386
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004387 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004388
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004389 Examples :
4390 compression algo gzip
4391 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004392
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004393
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004394cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004395 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4396 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004397 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004398 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4400 yes | no | yes | yes
4401 Arguments :
4402 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4403 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4404 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4405 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4406 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4407 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004408 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004409 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4410 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4411
4412 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004413 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004414 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4415 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4416 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4417 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004418 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4419 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004420 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004421 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4422 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004423
4424 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004425 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004426
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004427 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004428 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004429 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004430 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004431 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4432 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4433 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4434 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4435 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4436 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4437 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004438
4439 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4440 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4441 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4442 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4443 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4444 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4445 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4446 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4447 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004448 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004449 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4450 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4451 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004452
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004453 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4454 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4455 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004456 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4457 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4458 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4459 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004460 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4461 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4462 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004463
4464 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4465 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4466 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4467 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4468 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4469 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4470 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4471 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4472 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4473
4474 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4475 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4476 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4477 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4478 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4479 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4480 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4481 persistence cookie in the cache.
4482 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4483
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004484 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4485 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004486 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004487 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4488 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004489 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004490 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4491 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4492 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4493 they logout.
4494
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004495 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004496 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4497 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4498 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4499
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004500 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004501 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4502 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4503 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4504 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4505 this attribute.
4506
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004507 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004508 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004509 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4510 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4511 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4512 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4513 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4514 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004515
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004516 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4517 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4518 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4519 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4520 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4521 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4522 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4523 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004524 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004525 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4526 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4527 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4528 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4529 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4530 the site.
4531
4532 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4533 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4534 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4535 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4536 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4537 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4538 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4539 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4540 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4541 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4542 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4543 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4544 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004545 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004546 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4547 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4548
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004549 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4550 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4551 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4552 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4553 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4554 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4555
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004556 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004557 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4558 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4559 repeated.
4560
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004561 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4562 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4563 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4564 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004565
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004566 Examples :
4567 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4568 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4569 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004570 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004571
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004572 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004573
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004574
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004575declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4576 Declares a capture slot.
4577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4578 no | yes | yes | no
4579 Arguments:
4580 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4581
4582 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4583 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4584 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4585 for use in the response.
4586
4587 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004588 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004589 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4590
4591
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004592default-server [param*]
4593 Change default options for a server in a backend
4594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4595 yes | no | yes | yes
4596 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004597 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4598 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4599 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4600 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004601
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004602 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004603 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4604
4605 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004606
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004607
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004608default_backend <backend>
4609 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4611 yes | yes | yes | no
4612 Arguments :
4613 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4614
4615 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4616 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4617 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4618 will catch all undetermined requests.
4619
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004620 Example :
4621
4622 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4623 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4624 default_backend dynamic
4625
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004626 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004627
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004628
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004629description <string>
4630 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4632 no | yes | yes | yes
4633 Arguments : string
4634
4635 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4636 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4637 it describes.
4638 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4639
4640
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004641disabled
4642 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4644 yes | yes | yes | yes
4645 Arguments : none
4646
4647 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4648 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4649 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4650 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4651 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4652 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4653 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4654
4655 See also : "enabled"
4656
4657
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004658dispatch <address>:<port>
4659 Set a default server address
4660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4661 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004662 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004663
4664 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4665 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4666 during start-up.
4667
4668 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4669 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4670 possible with normal servers.
4671
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004672 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004673 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4674 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4675 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4676 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4677
4678 See also : "server"
4679
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004680
4681dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4682 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4684 yes | no | yes | yes
4685 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4686
4687 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004688 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004689 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4690 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004691 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004692 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004693
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004694enabled
4695 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4697 yes | yes | yes | yes
4698 Arguments : none
4699
4700 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4701 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4702
4703 See also : "disabled"
4704
4705
4706errorfile <code> <file>
4707 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4709 yes | yes | yes | yes
4710 Arguments :
4711 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004712 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004713 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004714
4715 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004716 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004717 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004718 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4719 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004720
4721 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4722 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4723 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4724
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004725 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4726
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004727 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4728 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4729 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4730 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4731 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4732 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4733 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4734 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4735 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004736
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004737 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4738 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4739 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004740 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004741 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4742
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004743 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004744
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004745 Example :
4746 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004747 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004748 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4749 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4750
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004751
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004752errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4753 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4754 section.
4755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4756 yes | yes | yes | yes
4757 Arguments :
4758 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4759
4760 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004761 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004762 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4763 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004764
4765 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4766 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4767 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4768 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4769 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004770 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004771 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4772
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004773 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4774 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004775
4776 Example :
4777 errorfiles generic
4778 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4779
4780
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004781errorloc <code> <url>
4782errorloc302 <code> <url>
4783 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4785 yes | yes | yes | yes
4786 Arguments :
4787 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004788 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004789 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004790
4791 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4792 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4793 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4794 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004795 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004796
4797 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4798 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4799 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4800
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004801 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4802
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004803 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4804 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4805 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4806 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004807 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004808 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4809 request.
4810
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004811 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004812
4813
4814errorloc303 <code> <url>
4815 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4817 yes | yes | yes | yes
4818 Arguments :
4819 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004820 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004821 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004822
4823 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4824 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4825 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4826 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004827 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004828
4829 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4830 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4831 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4832
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004833 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4834
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004835 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4836 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4837 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4838 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004839 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004840
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004841 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004842
4843
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004844email-alert from <emailaddr>
4845 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004846 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004847 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4848 yes | yes | yes | yes
4849
4850 Arguments :
4851
4852 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4853
4854 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4855 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4856
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004857 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004858 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4859 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004860
4861
4862email-alert level <level>
4863 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4864 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4865 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4866 yes | yes | yes | yes
4867
4868 Arguments :
4869
4870 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4871 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4872 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4873
4874 By default level is alert
4875
4876 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4877 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4878 for the proxy.
4879
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004880 Alerts are sent when :
4881
4882 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4883 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4884 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4885 is notice or lower
4886 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4887 and a health check status update occurs
4888
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004889 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4890 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004891 section 3.6 about mailers.
4892
4893
4894email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4895 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4896 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4897 yes | yes | yes | yes
4898
4899 Arguments :
4900
4901 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4902
4903 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4904 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4905
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004906 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4907 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004908
4909
4910email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4911 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4912 mailers.
4913 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4914 yes | yes | yes | yes
4915
4916 Arguments :
4917
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004918 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004919
4920 By default the systems hostname is used.
4921
4922 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4923 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4924 for the proxy.
4925
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004926 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4927 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004928
4929
4930email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004931 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004932 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4933 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4934 yes | yes | yes | yes
4935
4936 Arguments :
4937
4938 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4939
4940 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4941 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4942
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004943 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004944 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4945
4946
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02004947error-log-format <string>
4948 Specifies the log format string to use in case of connection error on the frontend side.
4949 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4950 yes | yes | yes | no
4951
4952 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for logs
4953 containing information related to errors, timeouts, retries redispatches or
4954 HTTP status code 5xx. This format will in short be used for every log line
4955 that would be concerned by the "log-separate-errors" option, including
4956 connection errors described in section 8.2.6..
4957 If the directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will
4958 use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4959 string in depth.
4960
4961 "error-log-format" directive overrides previous "error-log-format"
4962 directives.
4963
4964
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004965force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4966 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4967 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004968 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004969
4970 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4971 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4972 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4973 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4974 marked down for maintenance operations.
4975
4976 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4977 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4978 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4979 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4980 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4981 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4982 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4983 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4984 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4985
4986 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4987 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4988 is used.
4989
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004990 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004991 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004992
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004993
4994filter <name> [param*]
4995 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4997 no | yes | yes | yes
4998 Arguments :
4999 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5000 referenced in section 9.
5001
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005002 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005003 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005004 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5005 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005006
5007 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5008 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5009
5010 Example:
5011 listen
5012 bind *:80
5013
5014 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5015 filter compression
5016 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5017
5018 compression algo gzip
5019 compression offload
5020
5021 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5022
5023 See also : section 9.
5024
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005025
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005026fullconn <conns>
5027 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5029 yes | no | yes | yes
5030 Arguments :
5031 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5032 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5033
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005034 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005035 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005036 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005037 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5038 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5039 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5040 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5041 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005042 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005043
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005044 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005045 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005046 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5047 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5048 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005049
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005050 Example :
5051 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5052 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5053 # connections.
5054 backend dynamic
5055 fullconn 10000
5056 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5057 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5058
5059 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5060
5061
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005062hash-balance-factor <factor>
5063 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5065 yes | no | no | yes
5066 Arguments :
5067 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5068 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005069 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005070
5071 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5072 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5073 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5074 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5075 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5076 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5077 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5078
5079 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5080 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5081 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5082 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5083 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5084
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005085 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5086 consistent hashing mechanism.
5087
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005088 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5089
5090
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005091hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005092 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5094 yes | no | yes | yes
5095 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005096 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5097 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005098
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005099 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5100 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5101 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5102 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5103 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5104 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5105 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5106 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5107 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5108 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005109
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005110 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5111 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5112 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5113 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5114 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5115 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5116 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5117 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5118 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5119 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5120 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5121 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5122 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005123 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5124 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005125
5126 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5127
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005128 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005129 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5130 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5131 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005132 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5133 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5134 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005135
5136 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5137 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005138 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5139 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5140 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5141 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5142
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005143 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005144 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5145 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5146 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5147 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5148 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5149 parameter.
5150
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005151 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5152 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5153 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5154 used on strings.
5155
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005156 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5157
5158 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5159 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5160 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5161 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5162 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5163 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5164 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5165 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5166 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5167 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5168 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5169 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005170
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005171 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5172 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5173 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005174
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005175 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005176
5177
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005178http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5179 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5180 ones).
5181
5182 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5183 no | yes | yes | yes
5184
5185 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5186 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5187 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5188 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5189 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5190 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5191
5192 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5193 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5194 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5195
5196 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5197 below.
5198
5199 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5200 instance.
5201
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005202 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5203 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5204 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5205
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005206 Example:
5207 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5208 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5209 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5210
5211http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5212
5213 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5214 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5215 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5216 example, or to pass some internal information.
5217 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5218 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5219 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5220
5221http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5222
5223 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5224 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5225
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005226http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005227
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005228 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5229 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5230 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5231 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5232 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005233
5234http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5235 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5236
5237 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5238
5239 Example:
5240 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5241
5242 # applied to:
5243 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5244
5245 # outputs:
5246 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5247
5248 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5249
5250http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5251 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5252
5253 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5254
5255 Example:
5256 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5257
5258 # applied to:
5259 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5260
5261 # outputs:
5262 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5263
5264http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5265
5266 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5267 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5268 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5269
5270http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5271 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5272
5273 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5274 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5275 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5276 fallback.
5277
5278 Example:
5279 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5280 http-response set-status 431
5281 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5282 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5283
5284http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005285http-after-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005286 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5287 inline.
5288
5289 Arguments:
5290 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5291 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5292 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5293 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5294 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5295 (request and response)
5296 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5297 processing
5298 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5299 processing
5300 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5301 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5302 and '_'.
5303
5304 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5305 followed by some converters.
5306
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005307 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
5308 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
5309
5310 Examples:
5311 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5312 http-after-response set-var-fmt(sess.last_be_addr) %[bi]:%[bp]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005313
5314http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5315
5316 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5317 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5318 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5319 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5320 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005321 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005322 processing.
5323
5324 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5325 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005326 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005327 rules evaluation.
5328
5329http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5330
5331 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5332 details about <var-name>.
5333
5334 Example:
5335 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5336
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005337
5338http-check comment <string>
5339 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5340 it fails.
5341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5342 yes | no | yes | yes
5343
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005344 Arguments :
5345 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5346 rule fails.
5347
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005348 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5349 user-friendly error reporting.
5350
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005351 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005352 "http-check expect".
5353
5354
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005355http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5356 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005357 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005358 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5360 yes | no | yes | yes
5361
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005362 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005363 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5364
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005365 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005366 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005367
5368 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5369 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5370 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5371 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5372
5373 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5374
5375 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5376
5377 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5378
5379 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5380
5381 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5382
5383 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5384 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5385 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5386 is used.
5387
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005388 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5389 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5390 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5391 haproxy -vv.
5392
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005393 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5394
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005395 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5396 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5397 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5398 different ports or with different servers.
5399
5400 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5401 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5402 the port with a "http-check connect".
5403
5404 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5405 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5406 do.
5407
5408 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5409 unset-var or comment rules.
5410
5411 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005412 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5413 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5414 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5415 option httpchk
5416
5417 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005418 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005419 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005420 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005421 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005422 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005423
5424 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5425
5426 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005427
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005428
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005429http-check disable-on-404
5430 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005432 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005433 Arguments : none
5434
5435 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5436 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5437 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5438 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5439 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5440 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5441 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5442 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005443 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5444 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005445 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5446 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5447 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005448
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005449 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005450
5451
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005452http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005453 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5454 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5455 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005456 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005458 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005459
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005460 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005461 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5462
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005463 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5464 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5465 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5466 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5467 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5468 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5469 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5470 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5471 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5472 result is always conclusive.
5473
5474 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5475 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5476 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005477 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5478 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005479 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5480 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005481 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5482 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5483 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005484
5485 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5486 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005487 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5488 supported :
5489 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5490 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005491 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5492 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5493 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5494 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5495 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005496
5497 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5498 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005499 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5500 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5501 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5502 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005503 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5504
5505 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5506 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5507 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5508 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5509
5510 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5511 informational message reported in logs if an error
5512 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5513 log-format string.
5514
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005515 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005516 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5517 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005518 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5519 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5520 details on the supported keywords.
5521
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005522 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5523 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5524 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5525 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005526
5527 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5528 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5529 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5530 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5531 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5532
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005533 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5534 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5535 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5536 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5537 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5538 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5539 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005540
5541 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005542 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005543 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5544 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5545 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5546 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5547
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005548 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5549 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005550 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5551 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5552 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5553 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5554 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5555 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5556 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5557 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005558 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5559 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5560 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5561 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5562 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5563 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5564 insensitive on the header names.
5565
5566 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5567 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5568 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5569 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5570 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5571 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005572
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005573 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005574 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005575 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5576 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5577 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5578 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5579 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005580 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005581 trace).
5582
5583 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005584 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005585 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5586 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5587 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5588 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5589 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005590 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005591
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005592 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5593 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5594 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5595 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5596 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5597 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5598
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005599 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005600 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005601 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5602 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5603 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5604 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5605 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5606 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5607
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005608 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5609 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5610 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5611 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5612 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005613
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005614 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5615 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5616
5617 Examples :
5618 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005619 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005620
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005621 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5622 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5623
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005624 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005625 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005626
5627 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005628 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005629
5630 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005631 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005632
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005633 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005634 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005635
5636
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005637http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005638 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5639 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005640 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5641 health checks.
5642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5643 yes | no | yes | yes
5644 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005645 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5646
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005647 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5648 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5649 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5650 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5651 to invent non-standard ones.
5652
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005653 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5654 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5655 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5656 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5657
5658 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5659 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5660 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5661 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005662
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005663 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005664 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005665 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005666 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5667 to add it.
5668
5669 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5670 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5671 to the log-format rules.
5672
5673 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5674 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5675 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005676
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005677 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5678 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5679 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5680 request.
5681
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005682 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5683 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5684 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005685 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5686 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5687 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5688 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005689 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005690
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005691 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005692 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5693 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005694
5695 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5696 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5697 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5698 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5699 configured request authority.
5700
5701 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5702 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005703
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005704 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005705
5706
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005707http-check send-state
5708 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5710 yes | no | yes | yes
5711 Arguments : none
5712
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005713 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005714 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005715 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5716 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5717 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005718
5719 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5720 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5721 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5722 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5723 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005724 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5725 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5726 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5727
5728 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5729 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5730 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5731
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005732 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5733 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5734 checked in multiple backends.
5735
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005736 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005737 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5738
5739 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5740 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5741 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5742 one fails.
5743
5744 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5745 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5746 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5747
5748 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5749 server's queue.
5750
5751 Example of a header received by the application server :
5752 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5753 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5754
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005755 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5756 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005757
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005758
5759http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005760http-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005761 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005762 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5763 yes | no | yes | yes
5764
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005765 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005766 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5767 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5768 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5769 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5770 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5771 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5772 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5773 and '-'.
5774
5775 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5776
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005777 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
5778 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
5779
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005780 Examples :
5781 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005782 http-check set-var-fmt(check.port) "name=%H"
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005783
5784
5785http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005786 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005787 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5788 yes | no | yes | yes
5789
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005790 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005791 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5792 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5793 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5794 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5795 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5796 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5797 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5798 and '-'.
5799
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005800 Examples :
5801 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005802
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005803
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005804http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5805 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5806 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5807 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5808 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5810 yes | yes | yes | yes
5811 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005812 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005813 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005814 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005815 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005816
5817 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5818 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5819 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5820 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5821
5822 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5823 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5824 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5825 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5826
5827 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5828 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5829 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5830 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5831 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5832 chroot is performed.
5833
5834 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5835 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5836 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5837 considered.
5838
5839 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5840 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5841 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5842 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5843 considered as a raw string.
5844
5845 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5846 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5847 "content-type".
5848
5849 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5850 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5851 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5852 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5853 evaluated as a log-format string.
5854
5855 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5856 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5857 argument to "content-type".
5858
5859 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5860 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5861 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5862 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5863
5864 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5865 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5866 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5867 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5868 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5869 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5870 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5871 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5872
5873 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5874 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5875 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5876
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005877 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5878 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5879 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5880 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5881 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5882
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005883 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5884 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5885
5886
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005887http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005888 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5889
5890 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5891 no | yes | yes | yes
5892
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005893 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5894 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5895 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5896 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5897 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005898
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005899 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5900 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005901
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005902 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005903
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005904 Example:
5905 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5906 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5907 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005908
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005909 http-request allow if nagios
5910 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5911 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5912 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005913
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005914 Example:
5915 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5916 acl add path /addacl
5917 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005918
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005919 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005920
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005921 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5922 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005923
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005924 Example:
5925 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5926 acl setmap path /setmap
5927 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005928
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005929 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005930
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005931 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5932 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005933
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005934 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5935 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005936
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005937http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005938
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005939 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5940 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5941 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5942 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5943 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5944 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5945 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5946 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005947
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005948http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005949
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005950 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5951 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5952 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5953 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5954 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5955 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5956 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5957 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005958
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005959http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005960
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005961 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5962 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005963
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005964
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005965http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005966
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005967 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5968 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5969 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5970 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5971 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005972
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005973 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5974 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5975 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5976 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5977 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5978 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5979 instead.
5980
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005981 Example:
5982 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5983 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005984
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005985http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005986
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005987 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005988
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005989http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5990 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005991
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005992 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5993 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5994 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5995 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5996 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5997 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5998 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5999 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6000 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006001
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006002 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6003 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6004 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006005 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6006
6007 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6008 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6009 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6010 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006011
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006012http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006013
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006014 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6015 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6016 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6017 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6018 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6019 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006020
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006021http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006022
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006023 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6024 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6025 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6026 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6027 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006028
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006029http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006030
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006031 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6032 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6033 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6034 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6035 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6036 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006037
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006038http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6039http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6040 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6041 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6042 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6043 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006044
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006045 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6046 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6047 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006048 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006049 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6050 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6051 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006052 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006053 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006054
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006055http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6056 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6057 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6058 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6059
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006060http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6061
6062 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6063 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6064 pointed by <resolvers>.
6065 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6066 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6067 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6068 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6069 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6070 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6071 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6072 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6073 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6074 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6075 to 0.0.0.0.
6076
6077 Example:
6078 resolvers mydns
6079 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6080 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6081 timeout retry 1s
6082 hold valid 10s
6083 hold nx 3s
6084 hold other 3s
6085 hold obsolete 0s
6086 accepted_payload_size 8192
6087
6088 frontend fe
6089 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6090 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6091 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6092
6093 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6094 # which mean DNS resolution error
6095 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6096
6097 default_backend be
6098
6099 backend b_503
6100 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6101 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6102 # 503 error page to end users
6103
6104 backend be
6105 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6106 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6107 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6108 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6109 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6110
6111 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6112 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6113
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006114http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6115
6116 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6117 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6118 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6119 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006120 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6121 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006122
6123 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6124
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006125http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006126http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006127http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006128http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006129http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006130http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006131http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006132http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6133http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006134
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006135 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6136
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006137 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006138 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6139 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6140 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6141 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006142
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006143 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6144 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6145 the supported backend.
6146
6147 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6148 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6149 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6150 number of segments in the path.
6151
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006152 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6153 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6154 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6155 when improperly combined.
6156
6157 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6158 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6159 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6160 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6161 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6162
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006163 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006164
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006165 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6166
6167 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6168 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6169
6170 Example:
6171 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6172
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006173 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6174
6175 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6176 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6177
6178 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6179 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6180
6181 Example:
6182 - /#foo -> /
6183
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006184 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6185 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006186
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006187 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6188 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6189
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006190 Example:
6191 - /. -> /
6192 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6193 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6194 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006195
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006196 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6197 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6198
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006199 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006200 their preceding segment.
6201
6202 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6203 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6204
6205 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6206 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006207
6208 Example:
6209 - /foo/../ -> /
6210 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6211 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6212 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006213 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006214 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006215 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006216
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006217 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6218 removed as well:
6219
6220 Example:
6221 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6222 - /bar/../../ -> /
6223
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006224 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6225 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006226
6227 Example:
6228 - // -> /
6229 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6230
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006231 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6232 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6233
6234 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6235 ".", "_", and "~".
6236
6237 Example:
6238 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6239 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6240 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6241 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6242
6243 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6244 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6245
6246 Example:
6247 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6248 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6249
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006250 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006251 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006252
6253 Example:
6254 - /%6f -> /%6F
6255 - /%zz -> /%zz
6256
6257 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6258 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6259
6260 Example:
6261 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6262
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006263 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006264 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6265 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6266
6267 Example:
6268 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6269 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6270 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6271
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006272http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006273
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006274 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6275 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6276 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6277 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6278 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006279
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006280http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006281
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006282 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6283 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6284 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6285 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006286
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006287http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6288 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006289
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006290 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006291 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6292 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6293 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6294 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6295 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006296
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006297 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6298 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6299 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6300 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6301 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006302
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006303 Example:
6304 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6305
6306 # applied to:
6307 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6308
6309 # outputs:
6310 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6311
6312 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006313
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006314 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6315
6316 # applied to:
6317 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006318
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006319 # outputs:
6320 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006321
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006322http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6323 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6324
6325 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6326 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006327 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6328 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6329 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006330
6331 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6332 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6333 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6334
6335 Example:
6336 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6337 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6338
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006339 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6340 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6341 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6342 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6343
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006344http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6345 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6346
6347 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6348 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6349 query-string are replaced.
6350
6351 Example:
6352 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6353 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6354
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006355http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6356 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6357
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006358 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6359 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6360 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6361 against.
6362
6363 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6364 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6365 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006366
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006367 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6368 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6369 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6370 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6371 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6372 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6373 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6374 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6375 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006376 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6377 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006378
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006379 Example:
6380 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6381 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006382
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006383 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6384 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006385
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006386http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6387 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006388
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006389 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6390 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6391 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6392 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006393
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006394 Example:
6395 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006396
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006397 # applied to:
6398 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006399
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006400 # outputs:
6401 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006402
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006403http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6404 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6405 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006406 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006407 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6408
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006409 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006410 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6411 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006412 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006413 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006414 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006415 are followed to create the response :
6416
6417 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6418 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6419 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6420 ignored.
6421
6422 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6423 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006424 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006425 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6426 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006427
6428 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6429 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6430 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006431 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006432 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006433
6434 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6435 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6436 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006437 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006438 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006439 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006440
6441 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6442 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6443 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6444 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6445 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6446 as a raw content.
6447
6448 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6449 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6450 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6451 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6452 considered as a raw string.
6453
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006454 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006455 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6456 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6457 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6458
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006459 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6460 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006461 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006462
6463 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6464
6465 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006466 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006467 if { path /ping }
6468
6469 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6470 if { path /favicon.ico }
6471
6472 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6473 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6474 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6475
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02006476http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6477
6478 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
6479 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
6480 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6481 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6482 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
6483 at this index.
6484 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
6485 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
6486
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006487http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6488http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006489
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006490 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6491 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6492 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006493
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02006494http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6495 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6496 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
6497 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
6498 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
6499 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6500 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6501 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
6502 at this index.
6503 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
6504 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
6505
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006506http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6507 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006508
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006509 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6510 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6511 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6512 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006513
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006514http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006515
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006516 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6517 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6518 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6519 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6520 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006521
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006522 Arguments:
6523 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6524 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006525
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006526 Example:
6527 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6528 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006529
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006530 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6531 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006532
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006533http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006534
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006535 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6536 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6537 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006538
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006539 Arguments:
6540 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6541 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006542
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006543 Example:
6544 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6545 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006546
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006547 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6548 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6549 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006550
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006551http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006552
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006553 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6554 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6555 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6556 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6557 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006558
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006559 Example:
6560 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6561 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6562 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6563 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6564 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6565 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6566 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6567 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6568 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006569
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006570http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006571
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006572 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6573 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6574 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6575 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6576 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006577
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006578http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6579 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006580
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006581 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6582 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6583 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6584 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6585 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6586 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6587 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6588 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6589 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006590
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006591http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006592
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01006593 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
6594 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6595 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
6596 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
6597 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
6598 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
6599 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01006600 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
6601 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006602
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006603http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006604
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006605 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6606 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6607 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006608
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006609http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006610
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006611 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6612 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6613 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6614 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6615 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6616 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6617 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6618 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006619
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006620http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006621
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006622 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6623 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6624 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6625 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6626 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6627 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006628
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006629 Example :
6630 # prepend the host name before the path
6631 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006632
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006633http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6634
6635 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6636 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6637 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6638
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006639http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006640
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006641 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6642 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6643 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6644 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6645 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006646
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006647http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006648
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006649 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6650 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6651 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6652 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6653 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6654 values have higher priority.
6655 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6656 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6657 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6658 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6659 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006660
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006661http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006662
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006663 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6664 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6665 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6666 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6667 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6668 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6669 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006670
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006671 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006672
6673 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006674 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6675 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006676
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006677http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6678 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6679 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6680 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006681 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6682 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006683
6684 Arguments :
6685 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6686 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006687
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006688 See also "option forwardfor".
6689
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006690 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006691 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6692 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6693
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006694 # After the masking this will track connections
6695 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6696 http-request track-sc0 src
6697
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006698 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6699 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6700
6701http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6702
6703 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6704 expression.
6705
6706 Arguments:
6707 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6708 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006709
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006710 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006711 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6712 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6713
6714 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6715 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6716 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6717
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006718http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006719 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6720
6721 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6722 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6723 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6724 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6725 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6726
6727 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6728 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6729 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6730 results.
6731
6732 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006733 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6734 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006735
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006736http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6737
6738 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6739 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6740 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6741 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6742 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6743 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6744 information from the request.
6745
6746 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6747
6748http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6749
6750 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6751 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6752 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6753 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6754 path and the query string.
6755 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6756
6757http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006758http-request set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006759
6760 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6761 inline.
6762
6763 Arguments:
6764 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6765 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6766 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6767 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6768 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6769 (request and response)
6770 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6771 processing
6772 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6773 processing
6774 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6775 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6776 and '_'.
6777
6778 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6779 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006780
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006781 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
6782 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
6783
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006784 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006785 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006786 http-request set-var-fmt(txn.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
6787
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006788
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006789http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6790 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006791
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006792 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6793 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6794 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6795 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6796 agent name must be used.
6797
6798 Arguments:
6799 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6800
6801 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6802 configuration.
6803
6804http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6805
6806 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6807 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6808 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6809 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6810 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6811 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6812 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6813 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6814 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6815 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6816 action.
6817 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6818 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6819 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6820 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6821 you fully understand how it works.
6822
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006823http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6824
6825 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6826 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6827 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6828 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6829 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006830 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006831 processing.
6832
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006833 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006834 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6835 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6836 rules evaluation.
6837
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006838http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6839http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6840 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6841 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6842 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6843 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006844
6845 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6846 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6847 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006848 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6849 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6850 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6851 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6852 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6853 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006854 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006855 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6856 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6857 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006858 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006859 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6860 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6861 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6862 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6863 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006864
6865http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6866http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6867http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6868
6869 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6870 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6871 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6872 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006873 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006874 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6875 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6876 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6877 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6878 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6879 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6880 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6881
6882 Arguments :
6883 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6884 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6885 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6886 select which table entry to update the counters.
6887
6888 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6889 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6890 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6891 that table until the session ends.
6892
6893 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6894 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6895 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6896 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6897 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6898 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6899 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6900 useful information.
6901
6902 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6903 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6904 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6905 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6906 checks that make use of it.
6907
6908http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6909
6910 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006911
6912 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006913 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006914
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006915http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6916
6917 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6918 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6919 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6920 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6921 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6922 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6923
6924 Arguments :
6925 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6926
6927 Example:
6928 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6929
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006930http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6931 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6932
6933 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6934 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
6935 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
6936 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
6937 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
6938 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
6939 http-buffer-request".
6940
6941 Arguments :
6942
6943 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
6944 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
6945
6946 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05006947 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006948 bytes.
6949
6950 Example:
6951 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
6952
6953 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6954
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006955http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006956
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006957 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6958 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6959 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006960
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006961
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006962http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006963 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6964
6965 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6966 no | yes | yes | yes
6967
6968 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6969 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6970 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6971 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6972 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6973 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6974
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006975 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6976 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006977
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006978 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006979
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006980 Example:
6981 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006982
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006983 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006984
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006985 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6986 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006987
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006988 Example:
6989 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006990
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006991 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006992
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006993 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6994 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006995
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006996 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6997 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006998
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006999http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007000
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007001 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7002 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7003 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7004 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
7005 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7006 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7007 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7008 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007009
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007010http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007011
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007012 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
7013 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
7014 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
7015 example, or to pass some internal information.
7016 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
7017 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
7018 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007019
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007020http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007021
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007022 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7023 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007024
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007025http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007026
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007027 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007028
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007029http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007030
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007031 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7032 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7033 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7034 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7035 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7036 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7037 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007038
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007039 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7040 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7041 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7042 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7043 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007044
7045 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7046 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7047 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7048 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007049
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007050http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007051
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007052 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7053 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7054 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7055 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7056 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7057 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007058
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007059http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007060
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007061 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7062 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7063 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7064 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7065 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007066
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007067http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007068
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007069 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7070 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7071 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7072 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7073 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7074 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007075
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007076http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7077http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7078 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7079 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7080 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7081 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007082
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007083 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7084 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7085 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007086 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007087 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7088 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7089 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007090 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007091 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007092
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007093http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007094
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007095 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7096 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7097 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7098 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7099 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7100 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007101
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007102http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7103 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007104
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007105 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7106 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007107
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007108 Example:
7109 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007110
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007111 # applied to:
7112 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007113
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007114 # outputs:
7115 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007116
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007117 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007118
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007119http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7120 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007121
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007122 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007123 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007124
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007125 Example:
7126 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007127
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007128 # applied to:
7129 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007130
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007131 # outputs:
7132 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007133
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007134http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7135 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7136 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007137 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007138 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7139
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007140 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007141 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7142 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007143 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007144 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007145 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007146 are followed to create the response :
7147
7148 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7149 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7150 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7151 ignored.
7152
7153 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7154 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007155 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007156 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7157 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007158
7159 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7160 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7161 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007162 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007163 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007164
7165 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7166 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7167 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007168 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007169 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007170 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007171
7172 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7173 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7174 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7175 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7176 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7177 as a raw content.
7178
7179 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7180 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7181 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7182 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7183 considered as a raw string.
7184
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007185 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7186 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7187 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7188 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7189
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007190 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7191 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007192 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007193
7194 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7195
7196 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007197 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007198 if { status eq 404 }
7199
7200 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7201 string "This is the end !" \
7202 if { status eq 500 }
7203
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007204http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7205
7206 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
7207 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
7208 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7209 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7210 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
7211 at this index.
7212 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7213 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7214
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007215http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7216http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007217
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007218 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7219 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7220 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007221
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007222http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7223 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7224
7225 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
7226 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
7227 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
7228 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7229 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7230 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
7231 at this index.
7232 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
7233 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
7234
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007235http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7236 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007237
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007238 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7239 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7240 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7241 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007242
Christopher Faulet24e7f352021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007243http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7244 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007245
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007246 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7247 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7248 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7249 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7250 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007251
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007252 Arguments:
7253 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007254
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007255 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7256 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007257
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007258http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007259
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007260 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7261 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7262 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007263
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007264http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7265
7266 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7267 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7268 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7269 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7270 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7271
7272http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7273
7274 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7275 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7276 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7277 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7278 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7279 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7280 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7281 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7282 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7283
7284http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7285
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01007286 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
7287 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7288 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
7289 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace.
7290 It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
7291 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
7292 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01007293 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
7294 and OpenBSD.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007295
7296http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7297
7298 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7299 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7300 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7301 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7302 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7303 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7304 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7305 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7306
7307http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7308 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7309
7310 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7311 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7312 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7313 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007314
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007315 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007316 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7317 http-response set-status 431
7318 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7319 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007320
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007321http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007322
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007323 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7324 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7325 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7326 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7327 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7328 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7329 based on some information from the request.
7330
7331 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7332
7333http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007334http-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007335
7336 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7337 inline.
7338
7339 Arguments:
7340 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7341 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7342 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7343 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7344 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7345 (request and response)
7346 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7347 processing
7348 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7349 processing
7350 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7351 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7352 and '_'.
7353
7354 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7355 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007356
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007357 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
7358 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
7359
7360 Examples:
7361 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
7362 http-response set-var-fmt(sess.last_be_addr) %[bi]:%[bp]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007363
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007364http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007365
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007366 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7367 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7368 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7369 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7370 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7371 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7372 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7373 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7374 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7375 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7376 action.
7377 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7378 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7379 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7380 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7381 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007382
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007383http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7384
7385 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7386 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7387 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7388 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7389 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007390 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007391 processing.
7392
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007393 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007394 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007395 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007396 rules evaluation.
7397
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007398http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7399http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7400http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007401
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007402 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7403 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7404 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7405 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7406 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007407 supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007408
7409http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7410
7411 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7412 about <var-name>.
7413
7414 Example:
7415 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7416
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007417http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7418 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7419
7420 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7421 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7422 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7423 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7424 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7425 buffer is full.
7426
7427 Arguments :
7428
7429 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7430 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7431
7432 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007433 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007434 bytes.
7435
7436 Example:
7437 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007438
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007439http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7440 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7441
7442 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7443 yes | no | yes | yes
7444
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007445 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007446 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7447 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7448 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007449
7450 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7451
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007452 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7453 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7454 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7455 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7456 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7457 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7458 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007459 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007460 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7461 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007462
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007463 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7464 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7465 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7466 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7467 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7468 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7469 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007470 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7471 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7472 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7473 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7474 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7475 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007476
7477 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7478 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7479 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7480 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7481 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7482 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7483 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7484 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007485 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007486 downsides of rare connection failures.
7487
7488 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7489 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7490 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7491 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7492 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7493 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007494 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007495 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7496 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7497 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7498 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7499 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7500
7501 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007502 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7503 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7504 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7505 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007506
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007507 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7508 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007509
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007510 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007511
7512 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7513 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7514 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7515
7516 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7517
7518
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007519http-send-name-header [<header>]
7520 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007521 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7522 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007523 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007524 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7525
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007526 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7527 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7528 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7529 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7530 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7531 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7532 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7533 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7534 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7535 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7536 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7537 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7538 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7539 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7540 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7541 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007542
7543 See also : "server"
7544
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007545id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007546 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7548 no | yes | yes | yes
7549 Arguments : none
7550
7551 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7552 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7553 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007554
7555
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007556ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7557 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7558 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007559 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007560
7561 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7562 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7563 and running).
7564
7565 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7566 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7567 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007568 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007569 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7570
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007571 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7572 "unless" condition is met.
7573
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007574 Example:
7575 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7576 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7577 ignore-persist if url_static
7578
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007579 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7580
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007581load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7582 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7583 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7584 yes | no | yes | yes
7585
7586 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7587 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7588 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007589 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007590 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007591 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7592 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7593 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7594
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007595 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007596 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007597 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007598
7599 Arguments:
7600 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7601 named "server-state-file".
7602
7603 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7604 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7605 name is used as a file name.
7606
7607 none don't load any stat for this backend
7608
7609 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007610 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7611 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7612 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007613 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007614 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007615
7616 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7617 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7618
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007619 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007620
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007621 global
7622 stats socket /tmp/socket
7623 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007624
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007625 defaults
7626 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007627
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007628 backend bk
7629 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7630 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007631
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007632
7633 Then one can run :
7634
7635 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7636
7637 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7638
7639 1
7640 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7641 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7642 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7643
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007644 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007645
7646 global
7647 stats socket /tmp/socket
7648 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7649
7650 defaults
7651 load-server-state-from-file local
7652
7653 backend bk
7654 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7655 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7656
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007657
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007658 Then one can run :
7659
7660 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7661
7662 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7663
7664 1
7665 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7666 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7667 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7668
7669 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7670 "show servers state"
7671
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007672
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007673log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007674log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007675 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007676no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007677 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7679 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007680
7681 Prefix :
7682 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7683 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7684 prefix does not allow arguments.
7685
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007686 Arguments :
7687 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7688 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7689 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7690 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7691 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7692 parameter.
7693
7694 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7695 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7696
7697 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7698 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7699 standard syslog port).
7700
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007701 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7702 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7703 standard syslog port).
7704
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007705 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7706 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7707 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007708 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007709
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007710 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7711 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7712 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7713 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7714 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7715 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7716 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7717 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7718 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7719 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7720 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7721 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007722 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007723 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7724 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7725 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007726 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7727 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007728
7729 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7730 and "fd@2", see above.
7731
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007732 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7733 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7734 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7735 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7736 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7737 having the logs instantly available.
7738
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007739 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7740 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7741 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7742
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007743 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7744 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007745
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007746 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7747 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7748 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7749 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7750 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7751 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7752 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7753 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7754 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7755 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007756 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007757
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007758 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7759 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7760 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7761 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7762 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7763
7764 <sample_size>
7765 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7766 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7767 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7768 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7769 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7770
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007771 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7772 one of the following :
7773
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007774 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7775 field is stripped. This is the default.
7776 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7777 rfc3164.
7778
7779 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007780 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7781
7782 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7783 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7784
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007785 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7786 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7787 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7788 designed to be used with a local log server.
7789
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007790 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7791 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7792 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7793 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7794 systemd logger consumes.
7795
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007796 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7797 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7798 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7799 used with a local log server.
7800
7801 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7802 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7803 designed to be used with a local log server.
7804
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007805 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7806 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7807 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7808 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7809
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007810 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7811
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007812 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7813 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7814 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7815
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007816 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7817 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7818 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7819 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007820
7821 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7822 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7823 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007824 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7825 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7826 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7827 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7828 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007829
7830 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7831
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007832 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7833 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7834 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007835
7836 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7837 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7838 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7839 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7840
7841 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7842 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007843
7844 Example :
7845 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007846 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7847 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7848 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007849 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007850 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7851 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007852 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007853
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007854
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007855log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007856 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7857 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7858 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007859
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007860 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7861 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7862 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7863 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7864 string in depth.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02007865 A specific log-format used only in case of connection error can also be
7866 defined, see the "error-log-format" option.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007867
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02007868 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
7869 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007870
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007871log-format-sd <string>
7872 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7873 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7874 yes | yes | yes | no
7875
7876 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7877 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7878 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7879 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7880 which covers the log format string in depth.
7881
7882 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7883 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7884
7885 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7886 log format to "rfc5424".
7887
7888 Example :
7889 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7890
7891
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007892log-tag <string>
7893 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7894 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7895 yes | yes | yes | yes
7896
7897 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7898 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007899 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007900 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7901 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7902 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7903 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7904 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7905 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007906
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007907max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7908 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7909 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7910 yes | no | yes | yes
7911
7912 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7913 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7914 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7915 servers.
7916
7917 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007918 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007919 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7920 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7921 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007922 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007923 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7924 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7925 picking a different server.
7926
7927 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7928 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7929 even if they have to be queued.
7930
7931 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7932 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7933
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007934max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7935 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7936 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7937 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007938
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007939maxconn <conns>
7940 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7942 yes | yes | yes | no
7943 Arguments :
7944 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7945 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7946 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7947 closes.
7948
7949 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007950 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007951 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7952 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007953 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7954 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7955 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7956 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007957
7958 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7959 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7960 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7961
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007962 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7963 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007964
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007965 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7966
7967
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007968mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007969 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7971 yes | yes | yes | yes
7972 Arguments :
7973 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7974 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7975 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7976 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7977
7978 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7979 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7980 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7981 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7982 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7983
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007984 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7985 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7986 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007987
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007988 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007989 defaults http_instances
7990 mode http
7991
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007992
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007993monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007994 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7996 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007997 Arguments :
7998 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7999 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008000 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008001 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8002 backend and its backup.
8003
8004 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8005 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8006 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8007 servers in a list of backends.
8008
8009 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8010 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8011 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008012 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008013 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8014 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008015 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008016 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8017 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008018
8019 Example:
8020 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008021 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008022 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8023 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8024 monitor-uri /site_alive
8025 monitor fail if site_dead
8026
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008027 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008028
8029
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008030monitor-uri <uri>
8031 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8033 yes | yes | yes | no
8034 Arguments :
8035 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8036 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8037
8038 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8039 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8040 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8041 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8042 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8043 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8044 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8045 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8046
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008047 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008048 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8049 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8050 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8051 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8052 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8053 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008054
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008055 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8056 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8057 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8058 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8059
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008060 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008061 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008062 frontend www
8063 mode http
8064 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8065
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008066 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008067
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008068
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008069option abortonclose
8070no option abortonclose
8071 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8073 yes | no | yes | yes
8074 Arguments : none
8075
8076 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8077 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8078 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8079 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008080 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008081 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8082 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8083 encountered while delivering the response.
8084
8085 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8086 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8087 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8088 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8089 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8090 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008091 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008092 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008093 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008094 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8095 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8096 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8097
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008098 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8099 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008100 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8101 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8102 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8103 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8104 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8105 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008106 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008107
8108 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8109 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8110
8111 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8112
8113
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008114option accept-invalid-http-request
8115no option accept-invalid-http-request
8116 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8118 yes | yes | yes | no
8119 Arguments : none
8120
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008121 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008122 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008123 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008124 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8125 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8126 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8127 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8128 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008129 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8130 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8131 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8132 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008133 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008134 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008135 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8136 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8137 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008138
8139 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8140 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8141 been confirmed.
8142
8143 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8144 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008145 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8146 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008147 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8148
8149 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8150 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8151
8152 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8153 stats socket.
8154
8155
8156option accept-invalid-http-response
8157no option accept-invalid-http-response
8158 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8160 yes | no | yes | yes
8161 Arguments : none
8162
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008163 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008164 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008165 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008166 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8167 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8168 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8169 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8170 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008171 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8172 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8173 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008174
8175 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8176 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8177 been confirmed.
8178
8179 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8180 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8181 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8182 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8183
8184 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8185 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8186
8187 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8188 stats socket.
8189
8190
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008191option allbackups
8192no option allbackups
8193 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8195 yes | no | yes | yes
8196 Arguments : none
8197
8198 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8199 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8200 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8201 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8202 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8203 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8204 order between the backup servers anymore.
8205
8206 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8207 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8208
8209 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8210 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8211
8212
8213option checkcache
8214no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008215 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8217 yes | no | yes | yes
8218 Arguments : none
8219
8220 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8221 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008222 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008223 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8224 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008225 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008226
8227 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008228 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008229 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008230 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8231 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008232 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008233 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008234 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8235 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008236 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008237 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8238 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008239 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008240 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8241 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8242 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8243 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8244 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8245 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8246 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8247 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8248 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8249
8250 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008251 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8252 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8253 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8254 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008255
8256 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8257 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008258 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008259 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008260
8261 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8262 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8263
8264
8265option clitcpka
8266no option clitcpka
8267 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8269 yes | yes | yes | no
8270 Arguments : none
8271
8272 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8273 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008274 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008275 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8276
8277 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8278 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8279 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8280 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8281
8282 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8283 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8284 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8285 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8286 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8287
8288 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8289
8290 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8291 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8292 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8293
8294 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8295 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8296
8297 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8298
8299
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008300option contstats
8301 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8303 yes | yes | yes | no
8304 Arguments : none
8305
8306 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8307 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8308 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008309 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008310 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8311 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8312 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8313 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8314 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008315
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008316option disable-h2-upgrade
8317no option disable-h2-upgrade
8318 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8319 connection.
8320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8321 yes | yes | yes | no
8322 Arguments : none
8323
8324 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8325 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8326 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8327 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008328 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8329 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8330 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8331 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8332 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8333 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008334
8335 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8336 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008337
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008338option dontlog-normal
8339no option dontlog-normal
8340 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8342 yes | yes | yes | no
8343 Arguments : none
8344
8345 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8346 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8347 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8348 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8349 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8350 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8351 logged.
8352
8353 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8354 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8355 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8356
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008357 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008358 logging.
8359
8360
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008361option dontlognull
8362no option dontlognull
8363 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8365 yes | yes | yes | no
8366 Arguments : none
8367
8368 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8369 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8370 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8371 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8372 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8373 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008374 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8375 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8376 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008377
8378 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008379 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008380 would not be logged.
8381
8382 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8383 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8384
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008385 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008386 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008387
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008388
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008389option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008390 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8392 yes | yes | yes | yes
8393 Arguments :
8394 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8395 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008396 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008397 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008398
8399 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8400 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8401 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8402 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8403 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8404 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8405 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008406 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8407 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8408 possible that the client has already brought one.
8409
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008410 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008411 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008412 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008413 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008414 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008415 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008416
8417 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8418 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8419 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8420 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8421 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8422 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008423 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008424
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008425 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8426 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008427 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008428 are under the control of the end-user.
8429
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008430 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008431 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8432 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008433 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8434 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8435 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008436
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008437 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008438 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8439 frontend www
8440 mode http
8441 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8442
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008443 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8444 backend www
8445 mode http
8446 option forwardfor header X-Client
8447
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008448 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008449 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008450
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008451
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008452option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8453no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8454 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8456 yes | yes | yes | no
8457 Arguments : none
8458
8459 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8460 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8461 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8462 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8463 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8464 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8465 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8466
8467 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8468 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8469 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8470 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8471 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8472 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8473 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8474 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8475 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8476 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8477
8478 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8479
8480 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8481 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8482
8483 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8484 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8485
8486
8487option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8488no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8489 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8491 yes | no | yes | yes
8492 Arguments : none
8493
8494 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8495 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8496 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8497 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8498 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8499 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8500 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8501
8502 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8503 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8504 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8505 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8506 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8507 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8508 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8509 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8510 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8511 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8512
8513 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8514
8515 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8516 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8517
8518 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8519 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8520
8521
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008522option http-buffer-request
8523no option http-buffer-request
8524 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8526 yes | yes | yes | yes
8527 Arguments : none
8528
8529 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8530 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8531 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8532 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8533 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8534 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008535 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8536 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8537 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8538 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008539
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008540 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8541 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008542
8543
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008544option http-ignore-probes
8545no option http-ignore-probes
8546 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8548 yes | yes | yes | no
8549 Arguments : none
8550
8551 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8552 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8553 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8554 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8555 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8556 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8557 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8558 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8559 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008560 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8561 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008562 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8563
8564 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8565 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8566 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8567 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8568 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8569 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8570 are often the only way to detect them.
8571
8572 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8573 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8574
8575 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8576
8577
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008578option http-keep-alive
8579no option http-keep-alive
8580 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8582 yes | yes | yes | yes
8583 Arguments : none
8584
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008585 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8586 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008587 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8588 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008589 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8590 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8591 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008592
8593 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8594 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008595 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8596 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8597 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8598 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8599 situations where this option may be useful :
8600
8601 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008602 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008603
8604 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8605 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8606
8607 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8608 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8609 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8610 request.
8611
8612 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8613 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008614 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8615 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8616 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008617
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008618 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8619 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8620 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8621 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8622 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8623 not set.
8624
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008625 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8626 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8627 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008628
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008629 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008630 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008631 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008632
8633
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008634option http-no-delay
8635no option http-no-delay
8636 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8638 yes | yes | yes | yes
8639 Arguments : none
8640
8641 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8642 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8643 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8644 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8645 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8646 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8647 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008648 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008649 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8650 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8651 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8652 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8653 affected.
8654
8655 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8656 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8657 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8658 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8659 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8660 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8661 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8662 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8663 latency environments.
8664
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008665 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8666
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008667
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008668option http-pretend-keepalive
8669no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008670 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008672 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008673 Arguments : none
8674
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008675 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008676 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8677 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8678 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008679 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008680 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8681 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8682 consider the response complete.
8683
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008684 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008685 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008686 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008687 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008688 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008689 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8690
8691 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8692 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8693 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8694 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008695 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8696 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008697 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8698
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008699 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8700 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8701 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8702 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8703 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8704 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008705
8706 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8707 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8708
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008709 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008710 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008711
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008712
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008713option http-server-close
8714no option http-server-close
8715 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8717 yes | yes | yes | yes
8718 Arguments : none
8719
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008720 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8721 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8722 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8723 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008724 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8725 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8726 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8727 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8728 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8729 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8730 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8731 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8732 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8733 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8734 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008735
8736 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8737 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8738 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8739 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008740 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8741 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008742
8743 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8744 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008745 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8746 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8747 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008748
8749 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8750 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8751
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008752 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8753 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008754
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008755option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008756no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008757 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8759 yes | yes | yes | no
8760 Arguments : none
8761
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008762 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008763 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8764 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8765 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8766 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8767 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008768 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008769
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008770 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008771 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008772 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8773 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8774 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008775
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008776 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8777 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8778 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8779 front of an existing proxy.
8780
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008781 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8782
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008783 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008784
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008785option httpchk
8786option httpchk <uri>
8787option httpchk <method> <uri>
8788option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008789 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8791 yes | no | yes | yes
8792 Arguments :
8793 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8794 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8795 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8796 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8797 ones.
8798
8799 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8800 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8801 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8802
8803 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8804 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8805 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008806 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008807
8808 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8809 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8810 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8811 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8812 the lack of any response.
8813
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008814 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8815 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8816 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8817 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8818
8819 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8820 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8821 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008822
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008823 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8824 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008825 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008826 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008827 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008828
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008829 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8830 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8831 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8832 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8833
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008834 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008835 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8836 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8837 backend https_relay
8838 mode tcp
8839 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8840 http-check send hdr Host www
8841 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008842
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008843 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8844 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8845 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008846
8847
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008848option httpclose
8849no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008850 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8852 yes | yes | yes | yes
8853 Arguments : none
8854
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008855 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8856 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8857 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8858 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008859 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008860
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008861 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8862 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008863 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008864 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8865 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008866
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008867 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8868 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8869 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008870
8871 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8872 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008873 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8874 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8875 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008876
8877 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8878 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8879
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008880 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008881
8882
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008883option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008884 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008886 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008887 Arguments :
8888 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8889 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8890 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008891 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008892 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008893
8894 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8895 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8896 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8897 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8898 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8899 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8900 ports.
8901
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008902 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8903 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008904
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008905 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8906
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008907 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008908
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02008909option httpslog
8910 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
8911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8912 yes | yes | yes | no
8913
8914 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8915 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8916 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8917 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8918 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8919 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
8920 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
8921
8922 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8923
8924 See also : section 8 about logging.
8925
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008926
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008927option independent-streams
8928no option independent-streams
8929 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8931 yes | yes | yes | yes
8932 Arguments : none
8933
8934 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8935 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8936 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8937 receive data or not.
8938
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008939 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008940 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8941 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8942 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8943 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8944 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8945 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8946 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8947 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8948 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8949 socket buffers.
8950
8951 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8952 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8953 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8954 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8955 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8956
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008957 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008958
8959
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008960option ldap-check
8961 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8963 yes | no | yes | yes
8964 Arguments : none
8965
8966 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8967 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8968 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8969 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8970
8971 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8972 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8973
8974 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8975 configure it.
8976
8977 Example :
8978 option ldap-check
8979
8980 See also : "option httpchk"
8981
8982
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008983option external-check
8984 Use external processes for server health checks
8985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8986 yes | no | yes | yes
8987
8988 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8989 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8990 command".
8991
8992 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8993
8994 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8995
8996
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008997option log-health-checks
8998no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008999 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9001 yes | no | yes | yes
9002 Arguments : none
9003
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009004 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9005 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9006 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009007
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009008 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9009 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9010 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9011 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9012 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9013
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009014 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009015 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009016
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009017 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9018 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9019 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009020
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009021
9022option log-separate-errors
9023no option log-separate-errors
9024 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9026 yes | yes | yes | no
9027 Arguments : none
9028
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009029 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009030 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9031 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9032 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9033 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9034 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9035 provides very important information.
9036
9037 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9038 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9039 error logs.
9040
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009041 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009042 logging.
9043
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009044
9045option logasap
9046no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009047 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9049 yes | yes | yes | no
9050 Arguments : none
9051
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009052 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9053 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9054 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9055 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9056
9057 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9058 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9059 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9060 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9061 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009062 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009063 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9064 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9065 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9066 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009067 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009068
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009069 Examples :
9070 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9071 mode http
9072 option httplog
9073 option logasap
9074 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9075
9076 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9077 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9078 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9079 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9080
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009081 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009082 logging.
9083
9084
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009085option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009086 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9088 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009089 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009090 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9091 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009092 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9093 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009094
9095 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9096 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009097 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009098 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009099 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9100 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9101 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009102
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009103 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9104 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9105 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009106
9107 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009108 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009109 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9110 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9111 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9112 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9113 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9114 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9115 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9116
9117 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9118 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009119
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009120 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009121
9122 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9123 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9124 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9125 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009126 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009127 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009128
9129 See also: "option httpchk"
9130
9131
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009132option nolinger
9133no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009134 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009135 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9136 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009137 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009138
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009139 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009140 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9141 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9142 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9143 connections.
9144
9145 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9146 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009147 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9148 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9149 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9150 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9151 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9152 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9153 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9154 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9155 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9156 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9157 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9158 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9159 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009160
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009161 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9162 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9163 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9164 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9165 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009166
9167 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9168 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009169 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009170 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009171 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009172
9173 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9174 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9175
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009176 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9177 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009178
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009179option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9180 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9182 yes | yes | yes | yes
9183 Arguments :
9184 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9185 matching <network>
9186 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9187 header name.
9188
9189 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9190 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9191 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9192 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9193 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9194 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9195 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9196 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9197 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9198 possible that the client has already brought one.
9199
9200 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9201 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9202 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9203 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9204 header and requires different one.
9205
9206 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9207 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9208 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009209 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9210 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9211 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9212 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9213 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009214
9215 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9216 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9217 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9218 both are defined.
9219
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009220 Examples :
9221 # Original Destination address
9222 frontend www
9223 mode http
9224 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9225
9226 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9227 backend www
9228 mode http
9229 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9230
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009231 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009232
9233
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009234option persist
9235no option persist
9236 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9237 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9238 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009239 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009240
9241 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9242 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9243 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9244 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9245 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9246 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9247 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9248 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9249 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9250 redirected to another valid server.
9251
9252 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9253 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9254
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009255 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009256
9257
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009258option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9259 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9261 yes | no | yes | yes
9262 Arguments :
9263 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9264 PostgreSQL server.
9265
9266 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9267 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9268 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9269 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9270
9271 See also: "option httpchk"
9272
9273
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009274option prefer-last-server
9275no option prefer-last-server
9276 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9277 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9278 yes | no | yes | yes
9279 Arguments : none
9280
9281 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009282 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009283 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9284 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009285 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009286 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009287 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009288 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9289 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009290 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009291 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009292 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9293 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9294 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009295 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9296 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9297 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009298
9299 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9300 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9301
9302 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9303
9304
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009305option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009306option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009307no option redispatch
9308 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9309 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9310 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009311 Arguments :
9312 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9313 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9314 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009315 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009316 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009317 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009318 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9319 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9320 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9321
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009322
9323 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9324 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9325 be able to access the service anymore.
9326
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009327 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9328 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009329
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009330 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9331 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9332 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9333 following order:
9334
9335 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9336
9337 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9338 list, or
9339
9340 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9341
9342 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9343 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9344
9345 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9346 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9347 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9348 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9349
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009350 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009351 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9352 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009353
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009354 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9355 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9356
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009357 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009358
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009359
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009360option redis-check
9361 Use redis health checks for server testing
9362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9363 yes | no | yes | yes
9364 Arguments : none
9365
9366 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9367 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9368 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9369 find the "+PONG" response message.
9370
9371 Example :
9372 option redis-check
9373
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009374 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009375
9376
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009377option smtpchk
9378option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9379 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9381 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009382 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009383 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009384 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009385 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9386
9387 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9388 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9389 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9390
9391 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9392 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9393 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9394 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9395 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9396 dead server.
9397
9398 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9399 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009400 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009401 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9402
9403 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9404 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9405 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9406 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009407 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009408
9409 Example :
9410 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9411
9412 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9413
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009414
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009415option socket-stats
9416no option socket-stats
9417
9418 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9420 yes | yes | yes | no
9421
9422 Arguments : none
9423
9424
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009425option splice-auto
9426no option splice-auto
9427 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9429 yes | yes | yes | yes
9430 Arguments : none
9431
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009432 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009433 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009434 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009435 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009436 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009437 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9438 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9439 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9440 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9441
9442 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9443 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9444 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9445 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9446 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9447 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9448 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9449 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9450 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9451 keyword.
9452
9453 Example :
9454 option splice-auto
9455
9456 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9457 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9458
9459 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9460 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9461
9462
9463option splice-request
9464no option splice-request
9465 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9467 yes | yes | yes | yes
9468 Arguments : none
9469
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009470 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009471 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009472 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9473 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9474 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9475 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9476
9477 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9478
9479 Example :
9480 option splice-request
9481
9482 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9483 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9484
9485 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9486 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9487
9488
9489option splice-response
9490no option splice-response
9491 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9493 yes | yes | yes | yes
9494 Arguments : none
9495
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009496 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009497 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009498 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9499 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9500 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9501 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9502
9503 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9504
9505 Example :
9506 option splice-response
9507
9508 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9509 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9510
9511 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9512 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9513
9514
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009515option spop-check
9516 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9518 no | no | no | yes
9519 Arguments : none
9520
9521 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9522 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9523 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9524 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9525
9526 Example :
9527 option spop-check
9528
9529 See also : "option httpchk"
9530
9531
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009532option srvtcpka
9533no option srvtcpka
9534 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9536 yes | no | yes | yes
9537 Arguments : none
9538
9539 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9540 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009541 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009542 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9543
9544 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9545 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9546 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9547 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9548
9549 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9550 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9551 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9552 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9553 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9554
9555 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9556
9557 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9558 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9559 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9560
9561 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9562 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9563
9564 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9565
9566
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009567option ssl-hello-chk
9568 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9570 yes | no | yes | yes
9571 Arguments : none
9572
9573 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9574 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9575 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9576 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9577 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9578 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9579 hello message.
9580
9581 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9582 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9583 messages, which is appreciable.
9584
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009585 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009586 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9587 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009588
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009589 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9590
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009591
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009592option tcp-check
9593 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9594 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9595 yes | no | yes | yes
9596
9597 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9598 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9599
9600 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9601 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9602 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9603
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009604 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009605 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9606 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9607 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9608 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9609 only.
9610
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009611 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009612 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009613 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9614 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9615 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9616
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009617 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009618 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9619 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009620 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009621 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9622 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9623 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9624 the respective protocols.
9625 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009626 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009627
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009628 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009629
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009630 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9631 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9632 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9633 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009634
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009635 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9636 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9637 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009638
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009639
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009640 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009641 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009642 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009643 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009644
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009645 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009646 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009647 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009648
9649 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9650 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009651 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009652 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009653 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009654 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009655 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009656 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009657 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9658 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009659 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009660 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9661 tcp-check expect string +OK
9662
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009663 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009664 (send many headers before analyzing)
9665 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009666 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009667 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9668 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9669 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9670 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009671 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009672
9673
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009674 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009675
9676
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009677option tcp-smart-accept
9678no option tcp-smart-accept
9679 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9681 yes | yes | yes | no
9682 Arguments : none
9683
9684 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9685 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9686 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9687 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9688 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9689 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9690
9691 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9692 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9693 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9694 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9695
9696 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9697 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9698 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009699 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009700
9701 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9702 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9703 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9704
9705 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9706 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9707 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9708
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009709 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9710
9711
9712option tcp-smart-connect
9713no option tcp-smart-connect
9714 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9716 yes | no | yes | yes
9717 Arguments : none
9718
9719 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9720 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9721 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9722 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9723 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9724
9725 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9726 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9727 complex.
9728
9729 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9730 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9731 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9732
9733 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9734 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9735
9736 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9737
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009738
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009739option tcpka
9740 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9742 yes | yes | yes | yes
9743 Arguments : none
9744
9745 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9746 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009747 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009748 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9749
9750 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9751 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9752 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9753 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9754
9755 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9756 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9757 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9758 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9759 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9760
9761 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9762
9763 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9764 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9765 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9766 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9767 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9768 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9769 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9770 backends.
9771
9772 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9773
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009774
9775option tcplog
9776 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009778 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009779 Arguments : none
9780
9781 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9782 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9783 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9784 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9785 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9786 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9787 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9788 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9789
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009790 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9791
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009792 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009793
9794
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009795option transparent
9796no option transparent
9797 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009799 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009800 Arguments : none
9801
9802 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9803 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9804 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9805 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9806 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9807 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9808 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9809 appropriate server.
9810
9811 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9812 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9813
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009814 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009815 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009816
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009817
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009818external-check command <command>
9819 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9821 yes | no | yes | yes
9822
9823 Arguments :
9824 <command> is the external command to run
9825
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009826 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9827
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009828 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009829
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009830 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9831 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9832 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9833 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9834 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9835 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009836
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009837 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9838
9839 Environment variables :
9840 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9841 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9842
9843 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9844
9845 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9846
9847 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9848 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9849 for a UNIX socket).
9850
9851 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9852
9853 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9854
9855 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9856
9857 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9858
9859 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9860
9861 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9862 socket).
9863
9864 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9865 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9866
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009867 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9868
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009869 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9870 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9871 failed.
9872
9873 Example :
9874 external-check command /bin/true
9875
9876 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9877
9878
9879external-check path <path>
9880 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9882 yes | no | yes | yes
9883
9884 Arguments :
9885 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9886
9887 The default path is "".
9888
9889 Example :
9890 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9891
9892 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9893 "external-check command"
9894
9895
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009896persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009897persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009898 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9900 yes | no | yes | yes
9901 Arguments :
9902 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009903 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9904 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009905
9906 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9907 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009908 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009909 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9910 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9911 forwarded to this server.
9912
9913 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9914 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9915 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009916 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009917 a single "listen" section.
9918
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009919 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9920 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9921 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9922
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009923 Example :
9924 listen tse-farm
9925 bind :3389
9926 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9927 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9928 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9929 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9930 persist rdp-cookie
9931 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009932 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009933 balance rdp-cookie
9934 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9935 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9936
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009937 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9938 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009939
9940
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009941rate-limit sessions <rate>
9942 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9944 yes | yes | yes | no
9945 Arguments :
9946 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9947 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9948
9949 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9950 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9951 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009952 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009953 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9954 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9955
9956 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9957 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9958 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9959 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9960
9961 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9962 listen smtp
9963 mode tcp
9964 bind :25
9965 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009966 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009967
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009968 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9969 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9970 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009971
9972 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9973
9974
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009975redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9976redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9977redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009978 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9980 no | yes | yes | yes
9981
9982 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009983 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009984
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009985 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009986 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009987 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9988 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9989 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009990
9991 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9992 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9993 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9994 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9995 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009996 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9997 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9998 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9999 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010000
10001 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10002 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10003 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10004 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10005 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10006 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010007 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010008 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010009 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10010 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10011 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010012
10013 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010014 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10015 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10016 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010017 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010018 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10019 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10020 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10021 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010022
10023 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010024 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010025
10026 - "drop-query"
10027 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10028 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10029 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10030 with a location-type redirect.
10031
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010032 - "append-slash"
10033 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10034 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10035 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10036 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10037
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010038 - "ignore-empty"
10039 This keyword only has effect when a location is produced using a log
10040 format expression (i.e. when used in http-request or http-response).
10041 It indicates that if the result of the expression is empty, the rule
10042 should silently be skipped. The main use is to allow mass-redirects
10043 of known paths using a simple map.
10044
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010045 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10046 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10047 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10048 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10049 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10050 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10051 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10052
10053 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10054 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10055 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10056 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10057 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10058 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10059 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010060
10061 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10062 acl clear dst_port 80
10063 acl secure dst_port 8080
10064 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010065 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010066 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010067 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10068
10069 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010070 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10071 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10072 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010073 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010074
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010075 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10076 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10077 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10078
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010079 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010080 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010081
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010082 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010083 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10084 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10085 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010086
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010087 Example: permanently redirect only old URLs to new ones
10088 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10089 %[path,map_str(old-blog-articles.map)] ignore-empty
10090
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010091 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010092
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010093
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010094retries <value>
10095 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10096 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10097 yes | no | yes | yes
10098 Arguments :
10099 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10100 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10101 default value is 3.
10102
10103 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10104 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10105 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10106
10107 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010108 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10109 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010110
10111 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10112 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10113
10114 See also : "option redispatch"
10115
10116
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010117retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010118 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10119 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10120 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010121 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10122 yes | no | yes | yes
10123 Arguments :
10124 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
10125 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
10126 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
10127 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
10128
10129 none never retry
10130
10131 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10132 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10133
10134 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10135 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10136 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10137 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10138 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10139 processing the request.
10140
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010141 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10142 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10143 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10144 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10145 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10146 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10147 overflow attack for example).
10148
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010149 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10150 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10151 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10152 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10153 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10154 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10155 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10156 amplify denial of service attacks.
10157
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010158 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10159 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10160 considered to be safe to retry.
10161
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010162 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10163 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10164 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10165 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10166 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010167
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010168 all-retryable-errors
10169 retry request for any error that are considered
10170 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10171 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10172 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10173
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010174 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10175 not cumulative.
10176
10177 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10178 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10179 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10180 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10181
10182 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10183 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10184 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10185 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10186 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10187 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10188 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10189 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10190 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10191 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10192 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10193 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10194
10195 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10196 should not use this directive.
10197
10198 The default is "conn-failure".
10199
10200 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10201
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010202server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010203 Declare a server in a backend
10204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10205 no | no | yes | yes
10206 Arguments :
10207 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010208 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010209 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010210
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010211 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10212 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10213 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10214 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010215 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10216 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010217 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010218 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10219 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010220 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10221 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10222 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10223 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10224 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10225 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10226 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010227 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010228 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10229 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10230 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10231 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10232 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10233 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010234 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10235 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010236 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10237 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010238
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010239 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010240 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10241 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10242 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10243 adding this value to the client's port.
10244
10245 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10246 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010247 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010248
10249 Examples :
10250 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10251 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010252 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010253 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10254 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10255 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010256
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010257 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10258 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10259 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10260 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10261 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10262
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010263 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10264 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010265
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010266server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010267 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010268 this backend.
10269 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10270 no | no | yes | yes
10271
10272 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10273 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10274 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10275 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10276 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010277
10278 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10279 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10280
10281 global
10282 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10283
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010284 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010285 load-server-state-from-file
10286
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010287 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010288 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010289
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010290server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10291 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10292 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10294 no | no | yes | yes
10295
10296 Arguments:
10297 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10298
10299 <num | range>
10300 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10301 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10302 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10303 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10304
10305 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10306
10307 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10308
10309 <params*>
10310 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10311 keyword.
10312
10313 Examples:
10314 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10315 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10316 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10317
10318 # or
10319 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10320
10321 # would be equivalent to:
10322 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10323 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10324 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10325
10326
10327
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010328source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010329source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010330source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010331 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10333 yes | no | yes | yes
10334 Arguments :
10335 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10336 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010337
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010338 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010339 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10340 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10341 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10342 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10343 supported prefixes are :
10344 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10345 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10346 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010347 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010348 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10349 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010350
10351 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10352 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010353 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10354 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10355 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010356
10357 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10358 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10359 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10360 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10361 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10362 <addr>.
10363
10364 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10365 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10366 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10367 port.
10368
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010369 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10370 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10371 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10372 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010373 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010374 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10375 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10376 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10377 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10378 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10379 HTTP header.
10380
10381 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10382 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010383 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010384 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10385 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10386 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10387 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10388 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10389 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10390 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10391
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010392 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10393 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10394 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10395 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10396 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10397 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10398
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010399 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10400 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10401 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10402 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10403
10404 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10405 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10406 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10407 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10408 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10409 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10410
10411 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10412 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10413 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10414 there are two methods :
10415
10416 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10417 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10418 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10419 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10420 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10421 of the client ranges may be used.
10422
10423 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10424 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10425 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10426 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10427 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10428 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10429 same session.
10430
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010431 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10432 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10433 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010434 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010435
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010436 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10437
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010438 Examples :
10439 backend private
10440 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10441 source 192.168.1.200
10442
10443 backend transparent_ssl1
10444 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10445 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10446
10447 backend transparent_ssl2
10448 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10449 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10450 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10451
10452 backend transparent_ssl3
10453 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10454 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10455 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10456
10457 backend transparent_smtp
10458 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10459 # with Tproxy version 4.
10460 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10461
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010462 backend transparent_http
10463 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10464 # proxy.
10465 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10466
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010467 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010468 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10469
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010470
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010471srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10472 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10473 the connection on the server side.
10474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10475 yes | no | yes | yes
10476 Arguments :
10477 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10478
10479 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10480 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010481 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10482 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010483
10484 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10485
10486
10487srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10488 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10489 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10490 server side.
10491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10492 yes | no | yes | yes
10493 Arguments :
10494 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10495 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10496 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10497 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10498
10499 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10500 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010501 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10502 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010503
10504 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10505
10506
10507srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10508 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10510 yes | no | yes | yes
10511 Arguments :
10512 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10513 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10514 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10515 document.
10516
10517 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10518 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010519 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10520 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010521
10522 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10523
10524
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010525stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10526 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010528 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010529
10530 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10531 matched.
10532
10533 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10534 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10535
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010536 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10537 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10538 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10539 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010540
10541 Example :
10542 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10543 backend stats_localhost
10544 stats enable
10545 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10546
10547 Example :
10548 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10549 backend stats_auth
10550 stats enable
10551 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10552 stats admin if TRUE
10553
10554 Example :
10555 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10556 userlist stats-auth
10557 group admin users admin
10558 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10559 group readonly users haproxy
10560 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10561
10562 backend stats_auth
10563 stats enable
10564 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10565 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10566 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10567 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10568
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020010569 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
10570 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010571
10572
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010573stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10574 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010576 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010577 Arguments :
10578 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10579
10580 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10581
10582 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10583 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10584 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10585 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10586 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10587 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10588
10589 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10590 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10591 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010592 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010593
10594 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10595 report using "stats scope".
10596
10597 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10598 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10599 unobvious parameters.
10600
10601 Example :
10602 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10603 backend public_www
10604 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10605 stats enable
10606 stats hide-version
10607 stats scope .
10608 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010609 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010610 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10611 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10612
10613 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10614 backend private_monitoring
10615 stats enable
10616 stats uri /admin?stats
10617 stats refresh 5s
10618
10619 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10620
10621
10622stats enable
10623 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010625 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010626 Arguments : none
10627
10628 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10629 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10630 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10631 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10632 - stats auth : no authentication
10633 - stats scope : no restriction
10634
10635 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10636 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10637 unobvious parameters.
10638
10639 Example :
10640 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10641 backend public_www
10642 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10643 stats enable
10644 stats hide-version
10645 stats scope .
10646 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010647 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010648 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10649 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10650
10651 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10652 backend private_monitoring
10653 stats enable
10654 stats uri /admin?stats
10655 stats refresh 5s
10656
10657 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10658
10659
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010660stats hide-version
10661 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010663 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010664 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010665
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010666 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10667 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10668 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10669 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10670 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10671 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010672
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010673 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10674 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10675 unobvious parameters.
10676
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010677 Example :
10678 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10679 backend public_www
10680 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010681 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010682 stats hide-version
10683 stats scope .
10684 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010685 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010686 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10687 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010688
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010689 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10690 backend private_monitoring
10691 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010692 stats uri /admin?stats
10693 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010694
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010695 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010696
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010697
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010698stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10699 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10700 Access control for statistics
10701
10702 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10703 no | no | yes | yes
10704
10705 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10706 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10707 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10708 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10709 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10710 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10711
10712 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10713 instance.
10714
10715 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10716 about ACL usage.
10717
10718
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010719stats realm <realm>
10720 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010722 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010723 Arguments :
10724 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10725 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10726 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10727
10728 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10729 using a backslash ('\').
10730
10731 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10732 only related to authentication.
10733
10734 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10735 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10736 unobvious parameters.
10737
10738 Example :
10739 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10740 backend public_www
10741 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10742 stats enable
10743 stats hide-version
10744 stats scope .
10745 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010746 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010747 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10748 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10749
10750 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10751 backend private_monitoring
10752 stats enable
10753 stats uri /admin?stats
10754 stats refresh 5s
10755
10756 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10757
10758
10759stats refresh <delay>
10760 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010762 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010763 Arguments :
10764 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10765 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10766 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10767 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10768 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10769 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10770
10771 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10772 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10773 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010774 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010775
10776 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10777 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10778 unobvious parameters.
10779
10780 Example :
10781 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10782 backend public_www
10783 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10784 stats enable
10785 stats hide-version
10786 stats scope .
10787 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010788 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010789 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10790 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10791
10792 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10793 backend private_monitoring
10794 stats enable
10795 stats uri /admin?stats
10796 stats refresh 5s
10797
10798 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10799
10800
10801stats scope { <name> | "." }
10802 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010804 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010805 Arguments :
10806 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10807 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10808 section in which the statement appears.
10809
10810 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10811 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10812 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10813 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10814 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10815 exists.
10816
10817 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10818 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10819 unobvious parameters.
10820
10821 Example :
10822 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10823 backend public_www
10824 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10825 stats enable
10826 stats hide-version
10827 stats scope .
10828 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010829 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010830 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10831 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10832
10833 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10834 backend private_monitoring
10835 stats enable
10836 stats uri /admin?stats
10837 stats refresh 5s
10838
10839 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10840
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010841
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010842stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010843 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010845 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010846
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010847 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010848 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10849
10850 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10851 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10852
10853 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10854 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010855 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010856
10857 Example :
10858 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10859 backend private_monitoring
10860 stats enable
10861 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10862 stats uri /admin?stats
10863 stats refresh 5s
10864
10865 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10866 global section.
10867
10868
10869stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010870 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10872 yes | yes | yes | yes
10873 Arguments : none
10874
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010875 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010876 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10877 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10878 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10879 - IP (socket, server)
10880 - cookie (backend, server)
10881
10882 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10883 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010884 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010885
10886 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10887
10888
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010889stats show-modules
10890 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10892 yes | yes | yes | yes
10893 Arguments : none
10894
10895 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10896 values as a tooltip.
10897
10898 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10899 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10900 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10901
10902 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10903
10904
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010905stats show-node [ <name> ]
10906 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010908 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010909 Arguments:
10910 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10911 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10912
10913 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10914 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010915 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010916
10917 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10918 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10919 unobvious parameters.
10920
10921 Example:
10922 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10923 backend private_monitoring
10924 stats enable
10925 stats show-node Europe-1
10926 stats uri /admin?stats
10927 stats refresh 5s
10928
10929 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10930 section.
10931
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010932
10933stats uri <prefix>
10934 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010936 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010937 Arguments :
10938 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10939 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10940 query string.
10941
10942 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10943 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10944 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10945 possible to reach it in the application.
10946
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010947 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010948 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010949 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10950 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10951 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10952 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10953
10954 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10955 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10956 an address or a port to statistics only.
10957
10958 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10959 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10960 unobvious parameters.
10961
10962 Example :
10963 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10964 backend public_www
10965 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10966 stats enable
10967 stats hide-version
10968 stats scope .
10969 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010970 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010971 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10972 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10973
10974 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10975 backend private_monitoring
10976 stats enable
10977 stats uri /admin?stats
10978 stats refresh 5s
10979
10980 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10981
10982
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010983stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10984 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010986 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010987
10988 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010989 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010990 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010991 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010992 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10993
10994 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10995 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10996 the "stick-table" statement.
10997
10998 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10999 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11000 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11001 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11002 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11003
11004 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11005 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11006 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11007 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11008 transformation rules.
11009
11010 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11011 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11012 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11013 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11014 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11015 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11016 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11017
11018 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11019 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11020 ACL based conditions.
11021
11022 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11023 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11024 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11025 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11026
11027 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11028 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11029 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11030 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11031
11032 Example :
11033 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11034 # last 30 minutes
11035 backend pop
11036 mode tcp
11037 balance roundrobin
11038 stick store-request src
11039 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11040 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11041 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11042
11043 backend smtp
11044 mode tcp
11045 balance roundrobin
11046 stick match src table pop
11047 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11048 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11049
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011050 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
11051 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011052
11053
11054stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11055 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11057 no | no | yes | yes
11058
11059 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11060 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11061 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11062 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11063
11064 Examples :
11065 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011066 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011067
11068 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11069 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11070 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11071
11072
11073 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11074 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11075 backend http
11076 mode http
11077 balance roundrobin
11078 stick on src table https
11079 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11080 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11081 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11082
11083 backend https
11084 mode tcp
11085 balance roundrobin
11086 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11087 stick on src
11088 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11089 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11090
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011091 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011092
11093
11094stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11095 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11097 no | no | yes | yes
11098
11099 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011100 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011101 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011102 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011103 server is selected.
11104
11105 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11106 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11107 the "stick-table" statement.
11108
11109 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11110 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11111 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11112 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11113 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11114 address.
11115
11116 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11117 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11118 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11119 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11120 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11121 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11122 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11123 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11124 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11125 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11126
11127 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11128 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11129 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11130 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11131 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11132 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11133 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11134
11135 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11136 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11137 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11138 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11139
11140 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11141 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11142 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11143 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11144 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11145 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011146 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11147 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11148 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11149 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11150 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11151 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011152
11153 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11154 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11155 the request.
11156
11157 Example :
11158 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11159 # last 30 minutes
11160 backend pop
11161 mode tcp
11162 balance roundrobin
11163 stick store-request src
11164 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11165 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11166 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11167
11168 backend smtp
11169 mode tcp
11170 balance roundrobin
11171 stick match src table pop
11172 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11173 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11174
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011175 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011176
11177
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011178stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011179 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011180 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011181 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011183 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011184
11185 Arguments :
11186 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11187 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11188 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11189 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11190
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011191 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11192 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11193 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11194 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11195
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011196 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11197 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11198 instance.
11199
11200 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11201 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11202 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11203 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11204 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11205 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011206 to 32 characters.
11207
11208 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11209 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11210 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011211 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011212 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11213 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011214
11215 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011216 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11217 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011218 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11219 increase.
11220
11221 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011222 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11223 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11224 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011225
11226 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011227 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011228 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11229 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011230 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011231 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11232 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11233 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11234 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11235 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11236 parameter (see below).
11237
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011238 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11239 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11240 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11241 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11242 soft restart.
11243
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011244 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11245 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11246 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11247 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011248 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011249 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011250 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11251 if not expiration delay is specified.
11252
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011253 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11254 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11255 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11256 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11257 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11258 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11259 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11260 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11261 token.
11262
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011263 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11264 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11265 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11266 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011267 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11268 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11269 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11270 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11271 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11272 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11273 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11274 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11275 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11276 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11277 types and their arguments.
11278
11279 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11280 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11281 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11282 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11283
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011284 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
11285 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
11286 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
11287 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
11288 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
11289 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11290 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11291 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11292 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11293 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011294 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
11295 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
11296 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
11297 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011298
11299 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
11300 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
11301 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
11302 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
11303 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
11304 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
11305 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpc0 to gpc99,
11306 to ensure that the build of a peer update message can fit into the
11307 buffer. Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
11308 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
11309 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
11310 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011311 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
11312 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
11313 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
11314 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011315
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011316 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11317 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11318 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011319 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011320
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011321 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11322 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11323 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011324 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011325 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011326 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011327
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011328 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11329 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11330 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11331 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11332
11333 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11334 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11335 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11336 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11337 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11338 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11339
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011340 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
11341 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
11342 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
11343 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
11344 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
11345 elements: gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11346 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11347 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11348 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11349 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020011350 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
11351 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
11352 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011353
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011354 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11355 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11356 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11357 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11358
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011359 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11360 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11361 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11362 they were received.
11363
11364 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11365 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11366 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11367 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11368 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11369
11370 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11371 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11372 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11373 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11374 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11375
11376 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11377 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11378 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11379
11380 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11381 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11382 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11383 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11384 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11385
11386 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11387 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11388 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11389 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11390 the client side.
11391
11392 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11393 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11394 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11395 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11396 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11397 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11398 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11399
11400 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11401 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11402 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11403 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11404 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11405 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011406 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011407
11408 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11409 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11410 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11411 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11412 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11413 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11414
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011415 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11416 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11417 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11418 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11419 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11420
11421 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11422 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11423 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11424 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11425 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11426 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11427
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011428 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011429 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011430 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11431 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11432
11433 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11434 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11435 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11436 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11437 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11438 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11439 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11440 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11441 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11442 recommended for better fairness.
11443
11444 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011445 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011446 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11447 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11448
11449 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11450 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11451 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11452 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11453 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11454 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11455 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11456 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11457 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11458 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011459
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011460 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11461 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011462 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11463 reference it.
11464
11465 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11466 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011467 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11468 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11469 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011470
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011471 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11472 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11473 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11474 something that can be ignored.
11475
11476 Example:
11477 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11478 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11479 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11480 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11481
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011482 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011483 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011484
11485
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011486stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011487 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11489 no | no | yes | yes
11490
11491 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011492 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011493 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011494 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011495 server is selected.
11496
11497 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11498 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11499 the "stick-table" statement.
11500
11501 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11502 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11503 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11504 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11505
11506 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11507 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11508 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11509 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11510 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11511 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011512 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011513 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11514 rules.
11515
11516 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11517 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11518 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11519 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11520 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11521 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11522 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11523
11524 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11525 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11526 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11527 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11528
11529 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11530 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11531 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11532 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11533 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11534 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011535 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11536 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11537 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11538 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11539 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11540 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11541 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11542 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11543 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011544
11545 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11546
11547 Example :
11548 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11549 backend https
11550 mode tcp
11551 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011552 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011553 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011554
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011555 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11556 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11557
11558 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11559 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11560 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11561
11562 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11563 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011564
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011565 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11566 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11567 # at offset 44.
11568
11569 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11570 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11571
11572 # Learn on response if server hello.
11573 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011574
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011575 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11576 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11577
11578 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11579 extraction.
11580
11581
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011582tcp-check comment <string>
11583 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11584 it fails.
11585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11586 yes | no | yes | yes
11587
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011588 Arguments :
11589 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11590 rule fails.
11591
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011592 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11593 user-friendly error reporting.
11594
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011595 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11596 "tcp-check expect".
11597
11598
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011599tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11600 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011601 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011602 Opens a new connection
11603 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011604 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011605
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011606 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011607 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11608
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011609 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011610 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011611
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011612 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011613 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11614 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011615 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011616
11617 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011618
11619 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11620
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011621 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11622
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011623 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11624
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011625 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11626
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011627 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11628 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11629 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11630 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11631
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011632 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11633 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11634 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11635 haproxy -vv.
11636
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011637 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011638
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011639 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11640 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11641 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11642
11643 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11644 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11645 of the sequence.
11646
11647 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11648 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11649 do.
11650
11651 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11652 unset-var or comment rules.
11653
11654 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011655 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11656 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11657 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11658 option tcp-check
11659 tcp-check connect
11660 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11661 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11662 tcp-check send \r\n
11663 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11664 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11665 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11666 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11667 tcp-check send \r\n
11668 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11669 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11670
11671 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11672 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011673 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011674 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11675 tcp-check connect port 143
11676 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11677 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11678
11679 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11680
11681
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011682tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011683 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011684 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011685 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011686 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011687 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011688 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011689
11690 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011691 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11692
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011693 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11694 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11695 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11696 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11697 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11698 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11699 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11700 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11701 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11702 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11703
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011704 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011705 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11706 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011707 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11708 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11709 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11710
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011711 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11712 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11713 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011714 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11715 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011716 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11717 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011718 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11719 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011720 By default "L7OK" is used.
11721
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011722 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11723 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011724 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11725 supported :
11726 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11727 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011728 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11729 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11730 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11731 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11732 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011733
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011734 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011735 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011736 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11737 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11738 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11739 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011740 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11741
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011742 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11743 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11744 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11745 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11746
11747 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11748 informational message reported in logs if an error
11749 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11750 log-format string.
11751
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011752 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11753 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11754 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11755 followed by some converters.
11756
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011757 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11758 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11759 with the usual backslash ('\').
11760 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011761 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011762 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11763 used upper or lower case.
11764
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011765 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11766
11767 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11768 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11769 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11770 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11771 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11772 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11773 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11774 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11775
11776 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11777 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11778 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11779 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11780 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11781 expression.
11782
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011783 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11784 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11785 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11786 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11787 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11788 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11789
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011790 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11791 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11792 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11793 this exact hexadecimal string.
11794 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11795
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011796 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11797 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11798 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11799 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11800 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11801 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11802 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11803 size.
11804
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011805 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11806 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11807 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11808 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11809 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11810 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11811 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11812 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11813 in a binary string before matching the response's
11814 buffer.
11815
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011816 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011817 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011818 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11819 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11820 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11821 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11822 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11823 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11824 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11825 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11826 the null character.
11827
11828 Examples :
11829 # perform a POP check
11830 option tcp-check
11831 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11832
11833 # perform an IMAP check
11834 option tcp-check
11835 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11836
11837 # look for the redis master server
11838 option tcp-check
11839 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011840 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011841 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11842 tcp-check expect string role:master
11843 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11844 tcp-check expect string +OK
11845
11846
11847 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011848 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011849
11850
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011851tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11852tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11853 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11854 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011855 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011856 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011857
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011858 Arguments :
11859 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11860
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011861 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11862 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011863
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011864 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11865 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011866
11867 Examples :
11868 # look for the redis master server
11869 option tcp-check
11870 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11871 tcp-check expect string role:master
11872
11873 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011874 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011875
11876
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011877tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11878tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11879 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11880 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011881 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011882 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011883
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011884 Arguments :
11885 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011886
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011887 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11888 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011889
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011890 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11891 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11892 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011893
11894 Examples :
11895 # redis check in binary
11896 option tcp-check
11897 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11898 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11899
11900
11901 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011902 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011903
11904
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011905tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020011906tcp-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011907 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011908 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011909 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011910
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011911 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011912 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11913 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11914 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11915 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11916 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11917 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11918 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11919 and '-'.
11920
11921 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11922
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020011923 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
11924 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
11925
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011926 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011927 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020011928 tcp-check set-var-fmt(check.name) "%H"
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011929
11930
11931tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011932 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011933 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011934 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011935
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011936 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011937 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11938 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11939 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11940 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11941 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11942 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11943 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11944 and '-'.
11945
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011946 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011947 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11948
11949
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011950tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11951 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11953 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011954 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011955 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11956 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011957
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011958 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011959
11960 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11961 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011962 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11963 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11964 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11965 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11966 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11967 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011968
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011969 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11970 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11971 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11972 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011973
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011974 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011975 - accept :
11976 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11977 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11978 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011979
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011980 - reject :
11981 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11982 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11983 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11984 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11985 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11986 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11987 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11988 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11989 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11990 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11991 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011992 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011993
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011994 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11995 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11996 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11997 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11998 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11999 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
12000 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12001 hosts.
12002
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012003 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
12004 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
12005 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
12006 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
12007 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
12008 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
12009 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
12010 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
12011
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012012 - capture <sample> len <length> :
12013 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
12014 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
12015 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
12016 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
12017 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
12018 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
12019 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
12020 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012021 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
12022 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012023
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012024 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012025 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012026 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
12027 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
12028 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012029 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020012030 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012031 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
12032 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
12033 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
12034 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
12035 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
12036 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
12037 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012038
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012039 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012040 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012041 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012042 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012043 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
12044 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
12045 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012046
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012047 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
12048 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
12049 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
12050 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012051
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012052 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
12053 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
12054 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
12055 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
12056 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012057 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
12058 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
12059 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
12060 layer7 information is extracted.
12061
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012062 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
12063 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
12064 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
12065 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
12066 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012067
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012068 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>):
12069 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
12070 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
12071 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12072 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12073 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12074 no GPC stored at this index.
12075 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types
12076 (and not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate'
12077 data_types).
12078
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012079 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12080 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12081 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12082 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12083
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012084 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12085 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12086 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12087 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12088
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012089 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12090 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the
12091 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the
12092 value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
12093 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12094 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12095 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12096 no GPT stored at this index.
12097 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
12098 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
12099
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012100 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12101 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12102 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12103 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12104 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012105
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012106 - set-mark <mark>:
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +010012107 Is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the client
12108 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value
12109 is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by
12110 the routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace.
12111 It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
12112 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
12113 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works
12114 on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +010012115 on FreeBSD and OpenBSD.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012116
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012117 - set-src <expr> :
12118 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12119 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12120 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012121 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012122
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012123 Arguments:
12124 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12125 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012126
12127 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012128 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12129
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012130 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12131 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012132
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012133 - set-src-port <expr> :
12134 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12135 expression.
12136
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012137 Arguments:
12138 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12139 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012140
12141 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012142 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12143
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012144 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12145 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12146 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012147
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012148 - set-dst <expr> :
12149 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12150 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12151 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12152 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12153 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12154
12155 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12156 followed by some converters.
12157
12158 Example:
12159
12160 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12161 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12162
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012163 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12164 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12165
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012166 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12167 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12168 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12169 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12170
12171
12172 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12173 followed by some converters.
12174
12175 Example:
12176
12177 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12178
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012179 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12180 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12181 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12182
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012183 - set-tos <tos>:
12184 Is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12185 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
12186 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed
12187 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only
12188 the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
12189 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border
12190 routers based on some information from the request.
12191
12192 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
12193
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012194 - "silent-drop" :
12195 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012196 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012197 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12198 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12199 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12200 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12201 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012202 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12203 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012204 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12205 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012206 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012207 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12208 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12209 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12210 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12211
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012212 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12213 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12214 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012215
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012216 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12217 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12218 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012219
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012220 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012221 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012222 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012223
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012224 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12225 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12226 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012227
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012228 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012229 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12230 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012231
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012232 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12233
12234 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12235
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012236 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12237
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012238 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012239
12240
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012241tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12242 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012244 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012245 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012246 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12247 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012248
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012249 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012250
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012251 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012252 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12253 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012254 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12255 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012256
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012257 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12258 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12259 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12260 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012261 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012262 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012263 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12264 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12265 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12266 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012267 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012268 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012269
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012270 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12271 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12272 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12273 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012274
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012275 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012276 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012277 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012278 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12279 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012280 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012281 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012282 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012283 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012284 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012285 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012286 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012287 - set-dst <expr>
12288 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012289 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012290 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012291 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012292 - set-tos <tos>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012293 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012294 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012295 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012296 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012297 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012298 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012299 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012300
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012301 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12302 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012303 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12304 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012305
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012306 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12307 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12308 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12309 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12310 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12311 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012312
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012313 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012314 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12315 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012316
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012317 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12318 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12319 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12320 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12321 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12322 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12323
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012324 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012325 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12326 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12327 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12328 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12329 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12330 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12331 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12332 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12333 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12334 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012335
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012336 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012337 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12338 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12339 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012340
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012341 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12342 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12343
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012344 The "set-log-level" is used to set the log level of the current session. More
12345 information on how to use it at "http-request set-log-level".
12346
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012347 The "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK in all packets sent to the
12348 client. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-mark".
12349
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012350 The "set-nice" is used to set the "nice" factor of the current session. More
12351 information on how to use it at "http-request set-nice".
12352
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012353 The "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
12354 the client. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-tos".
12355
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012356 The "set-var" and "set-var-fmt" are used to set the contents of a variable.
12357 The variable is declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only
12358 session-level variables can be used, without any layer7 contents. The
12359 "set-var" action takes a regular expression while "set-var-fmt" takes a
12360 format string.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012361
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012362 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12363 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012364 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012365 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12366 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012367 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012368 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012369 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012370 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12371 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012372 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012373 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12374 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012375
12376 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12377 followed by some converters.
12378
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012379 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
12380 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
12381
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012382 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012383 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12384 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12385 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12386 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12387 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12388 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsin3df59892021-05-10 12:50:00 +050012389 warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012390 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12391 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12392
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012393 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12394
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012395 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12396 <var-name>.
12397
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012398 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12399 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12400 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12401 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12402 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12403
12404 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12405 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12406 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12407 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12408 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12409 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12410 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12411 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12412 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12413 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12414 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12415
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012416 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12417 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12418 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12419 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12420 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12421
12422 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12423
12424 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12425
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012426 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12427 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12428 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12429 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12430 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12431 evaluated.
12432
12433 Example:
12434 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12435
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012436 Example:
12437
12438 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012439 tcp-request content set-var-fmt(sess.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012440 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012441
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012442 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012443 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012444 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012445 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12446 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012447 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012448 tcp-request content reject
12449
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012450 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12451 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12452 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12453 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12454 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12455 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12456 ...
12457 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12458
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012459 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012460 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12461 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12462 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012463 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012464
12465 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12466 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12467 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012468 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012469 tcp-request content reject
12470
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012471 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012472 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012473 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012474 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012475 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12476 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012477
12478 Example:
12479 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12480 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012481 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012482
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012483 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012484 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012485
12486 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012487 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012488 # protecting all our sites
12489 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012490 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12491 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012492 ...
12493 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12494
12495 backend http_dynamic
12496 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012497 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012498 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012499 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012500 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012501 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012502 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012503
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012504 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012505
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012506 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12507 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012508
12509
12510tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12511 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012513 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012514 Arguments :
12515 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12516 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12517 as explained at the top of this document.
12518
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012519 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012520 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12521 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12522 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12523 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12524
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012525 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12526 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12527 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12528 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12529
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012530 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012531 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012532 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012533 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012534 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012535 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12536 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12537 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012538
12539 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12540 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12541 it pass through unaffected.
12542
12543 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12544 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12545 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012546 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012547 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12548 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012549 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12550 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12551 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012552
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012553 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012554 "timeout client".
12555
12556
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012557tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12558 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12560 no | no | yes | yes
12561 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012562 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12563 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012564
12565 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12566
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012567 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012568 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12569 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012570 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12571 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012572
12573 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12574
12575 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12576 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12577 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12578 inserted.
12579
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012580 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012581 - accept :
12582 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12583 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12584 the rules evaluation.
12585
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012586 - close :
12587 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12588 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12589 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12590 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12591 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12592 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012593 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012594 protocols.
12595
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012596 - reject :
12597 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12598 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012599 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012600
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012601 - set-log-level <level>
12602 The "set-log-level" is used to set the log level of the current
12603 session. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12604 set-log-level".
12605
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012606 - set-mark <mark>
12607 The "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK in all packets sent to
12608 the client. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12609 set-mark".
12610
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012611 - set-nice <nice>
12612 The "set-nice" is used to set the "nice" factor of the current
12613 session. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12614 set-nice".
12615
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012616 - set-tos <tos>
12617 The "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets
12618 sent to the client. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12619 set-tos".
12620
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012621 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreaue7267122021-09-02 20:51:21 +020012622 Sets a variable from an expression.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012623
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012624 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt>
12625 Sets a variable from a log format string.
12626
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012627 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12628 Unsets a variable.
12629
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012630 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>):
12631 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
12632 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
12633 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12634 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12635 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12636 no GPC stored at this index.
12637 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types
12638 (and not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate'
12639 data_types).
12640
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012641 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12642 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12643 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12644 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12645
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012646 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12647 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12648 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12649 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12650
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012651 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12652 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the
12653 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the
12654 value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
12655 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12656 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12657 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12658 no GPT stored at this index.
12659 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
12660 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
12661
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012662 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12663 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12664 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12665 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12666 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012667
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012668 - "silent-drop" :
12669 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012670 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012671 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12672 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12673 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12674 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12675 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012676 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12677 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012678 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12679 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012680 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012681 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12682 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12683 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12684 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12685
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012686 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12687 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12688
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012689 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12690 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12691 for changing the default action to a reject.
12692
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012693 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12694 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12695 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12696 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012697 period.
12698
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012699 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12700 declared inline.
12701
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012702 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12703 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012704 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012705 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12706 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012707 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012708 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012709 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012710 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12711 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012712 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012713 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12714 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012715
12716 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12717 followed by some converters.
12718
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012719 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
12720 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
12721
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012722 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12723 <var-name>.
12724
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012725 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12726 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12727 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12728 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12729 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12730
12731 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12732
12733 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12734
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012735 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12736
12737 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12738
12739
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012740tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12741 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12743 no | yes | yes | no
12744 Arguments :
12745 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12746 below.
12747
12748 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12749
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012750 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012751 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12752 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12753 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12754 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12755 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12756 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12757 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012758 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012759 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12760 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12761 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12762 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12763 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12764 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12765 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12766 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12767 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12768 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12769 instead.
12770
12771 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12772 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12773 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12774 rules which may be inserted.
12775
12776 Several types of actions are supported :
12777 - accept : the request is accepted
12778 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12779 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012780 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012781 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012782 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012783 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012784 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012785 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet14aec6e2021-06-23 12:19:25 +020012786 - set-dst <expr>
12787 - set-dst-port <expr>
12788 - set-src <expr>
12789 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012790 - set-tos <tos>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012791 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012792 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012793 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012794 - silent-drop
12795
12796 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12797 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12798 sections for a complete description.
12799
12800 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12801 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12802 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12803
12804 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12805 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12806 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12807 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12808 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12809
12810 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12811 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12812
12813 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12814 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12815 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12816
12817 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12818 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12819 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12820
12821 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12822 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12823 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12824
12825 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12826 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12827 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12828
12829 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12830
12831 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12832
12833
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012834tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12835 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12837 no | no | yes | yes
12838 Arguments :
12839 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12840 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12841 as explained at the top of this document.
12842
12843 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12844
12845
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012846timeout check <timeout>
12847 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12848 established.
12849
12850 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12851 yes | no | yes | yes
12852 Arguments:
12853 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12854 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12855 as explained at the top of this document.
12856
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012857 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012858 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012859 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012860 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012861 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12862 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12863 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012864
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012865 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012866 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12867
12868 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12869 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012870 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012871
12872 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12873 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12874 forget about it.
12875
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012876 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12877 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012878
12879
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012880timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012881 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12883 yes | yes | yes | no
12884 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012885 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012886 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12887 as explained at the top of this document.
12888
12889 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12890 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12891 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012892 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12893 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12894 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12895 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012896 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12897 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12898 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012899 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012900 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012901 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12902 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012903 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12904 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012905
12906 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12907 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12908 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12909 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012910 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012911 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12912
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012913 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012914
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012915 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012916
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012917
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012918timeout client-fin <timeout>
12919 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12921 yes | yes | yes | no
12922 Arguments :
12923 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12924 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12925 as explained at the top of this document.
12926
12927 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12928 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12929 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12930 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12931 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12932 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12933 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012934 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12935 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12936 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012937
12938 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12939 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12940 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12941
12942 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12943
12944
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012945timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012946 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12948 yes | no | yes | yes
12949 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012950 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012951 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12952 as explained at the top of this document.
12953
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012954 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012955 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012956 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012957 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012958 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12959 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012960
12961 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12962 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12963 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12964 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012965 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012966 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12967
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012968 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012969
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012970
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012971timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12972 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12974 yes | yes | yes | yes
12975 Arguments :
12976 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12977 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12978 as explained at the top of this document.
12979
12980 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12981 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12982 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12983 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12984 once the request has started to present itself.
12985
12986 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12987 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12988 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12989 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12990 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12991
12992 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12993 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12994 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12995 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12996
12997 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12998 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012999 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013000 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
13001 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020013002 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013003
13004 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
13005 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
13006 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
13007 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
13008
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013009 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
13010 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010013011 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
13012
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013013 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
13014
13015
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013016timeout http-request <timeout>
13017 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
13018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013019 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013020 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013021 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013022 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13023 as explained at the top of this document.
13024
13025 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
13026 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
13027 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
13028 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
13029 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
13030 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
13031 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013032 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
13033 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
13034 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
13035 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013036 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013037 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
13038 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013039
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013040 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
13041 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
13042 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
13043 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
13044 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013045 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013046
13047 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
13048 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013049 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013050 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
13051 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
13052
13053 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013054 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
13055 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
13056 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013057
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013058 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013059 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013060
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013061
13062timeout queue <timeout>
13063 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13065 yes | no | yes | yes
13066 Arguments :
13067 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13068 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13069 as explained at the top of this document.
13070
13071 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13072 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13073 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13074 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13075 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13076
13077 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13078 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13079 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13080 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13081
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013082 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013083
13084
13085timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013086 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13088 yes | no | yes | yes
13089 Arguments :
13090 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13091 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13092 as explained at the top of this document.
13093
13094 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13095 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13096 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13097 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13098 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13099 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13100 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13101
13102 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13103 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13104 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13105 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13106 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013107 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013108 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013109 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13110 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013111 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13112 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013113
13114 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13115 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13116 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13117 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013118 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013119 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13120
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013121 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013122
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013123
13124timeout server-fin <timeout>
13125 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13127 yes | no | yes | yes
13128 Arguments :
13129 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13130 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13131 as explained at the top of this document.
13132
13133 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13134 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13135 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13136 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13137 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13138 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13139 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13140 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13141 situations, it should not be needed.
13142
13143 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13144 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13145 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13146
13147 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13148
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013149
13150timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013151 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13153 yes | yes | yes | yes
13154 Arguments :
13155 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13156 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13157 as explained at the top of this document.
13158
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013159 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13160 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13161 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013162
13163 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13164 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13165 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13166 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013167 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013168
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013169 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013170
13171
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013172timeout tunnel <timeout>
13173 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13175 yes | no | yes | yes
13176 Arguments :
13177 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13178 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13179 as explained at the top of this document.
13180
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013181 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013182 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13183 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13184 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013185 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13186 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013187 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13188 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13189 specified.
13190
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013191 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13192 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13193 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13194 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13195 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13196 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13197 state.
13198
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013199 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13200 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13201 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13202 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013203 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013204
13205 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13206 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13207 forget about it.
13208
13209 Example :
13210 defaults http
13211 option http-server-close
13212 timeout connect 5s
13213 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013214 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013215 timeout server 30s
13216 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13217
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013218 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013219
13220
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013221transparent (deprecated)
13222 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013224 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013225 Arguments : none
13226
13227 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13228 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13229 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13230 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13231 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13232 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13233 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13234 appropriate server.
13235
13236 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13237
13238 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13239 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13240
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013241 See also: "option transparent"
13242
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013243unique-id-format <string>
13244 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13246 yes | yes | yes | no
13247 Arguments :
13248 <string> is a log-format string.
13249
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013250 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13251 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13252 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13253 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013254
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013255 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013256 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013257 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13258 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13259 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13260 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13261 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13262 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013263
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013264 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13265 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013266
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013267 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013268
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013269 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013270
13271 will generate:
13272
13273 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13274
13275 See also: "unique-id-header"
13276
13277unique-id-header <name>
13278 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13280 yes | yes | yes | no
13281 Arguments :
13282 <name> is the name of the header.
13283
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013284 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13285 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013286
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013287 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013288
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013289 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013290 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13291
13292 will generate:
13293
13294 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13295
13296 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013297
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013298use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013299 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13301 no | yes | yes | no
13302 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013303 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13304 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013305
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013306 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13307 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013308
13309 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13310 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13311 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013312 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013313 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013314 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13315 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013316
13317 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13318 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13319 assign the backend.
13320
13321 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13322 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13323 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13324 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13325 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13326 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13327
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013328 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013329 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013330 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13331 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13332 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13333
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013334 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13335 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13336 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13337 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13338 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13339 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13340 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13341 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13342 cannot be forced from the request.
13343
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013344 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013345 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13346 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13347
13348 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13349 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013350
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013351use-fcgi-app <name>
13352 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13354 no | no | yes | yes
13355 Arguments :
13356 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13357
13358 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013359
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013360use-server <server> if <condition>
13361use-server <server> unless <condition>
13362 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13364 no | no | yes | yes
13365 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013366 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13367 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013368
13369 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13370
13371 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13372 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13373 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13374
13375 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13376 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13377 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13378 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13379 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13380 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13381 matches will assign the server.
13382
13383 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13384 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13385 with the next rules until one matches.
13386
13387 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13388 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13389 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13390 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13391
13392 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13393 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13394 stripped.
13395
13396 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13397 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013398 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013399 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013400 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013401
13402 Example :
13403 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013404 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013405 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013406 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013407 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013408 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013409 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013410 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13411 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13412
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013413 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13414 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13415 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13416 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013417 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013418 and we fall back to load balancing.
13419
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013420 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013421
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013422
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100134235. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013424--------------------------
13425
13426The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13427depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13428settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13429written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13430described in this section.
13431
13432
134335.1. Bind options
13434-----------------
13435
13436The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13437as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13438no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13439parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13440while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13441provided immediately after the setting name.
13442
13443The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13444
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013445accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13446 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13447 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13448 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13449 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13450 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13451 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13452 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13453 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13454 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013455 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13456 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13457 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013458
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013459accept-proxy
13460 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013461 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13462 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013463 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13464 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13465 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13466 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013467 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013468 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13469 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013470 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13471 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013472
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013473allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013474 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013475 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013476 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013477 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13478 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013479
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013480alpn <protocols>
13481 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13482 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13483 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013484 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013485 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013486 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13487 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13488 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13489 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13490 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13491 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13492 preference, like below :
13493
13494 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013495
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013496backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013497 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013498 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13499
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013500curves <curves>
13501 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13502 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13503 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13504 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13505 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13506 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13507
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013508ecdhe <named curve>
13509 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013510 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13511 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013512
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013513ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013514 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13515 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13516 client's certificate.
13517
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013518ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13519 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13520 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13521 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13522 error is ignored.
13523
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013524ca-sign-file <cafile>
13525 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13526 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13527 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13528 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13529 'generate-certificates' for details.
13530
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013531ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013532 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13533 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13534 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13535 'generate-certificates' for details.
13536
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013537ca-verify-file <cafile>
13538 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13539 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13540 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13541 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13542 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13543
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013544ciphers <ciphers>
13545 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13546 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013547 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013548 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013549 information and recommendations see e.g.
13550 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13551 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13552 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13553
13554ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13555 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13556 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13557 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13558 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013559 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13560 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013561
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013562crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013563 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13564 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013565 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13566 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013567
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013568crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013569 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13570 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13571 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13572 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13573 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013574 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13575 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013576
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013577 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13578 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13579
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013580 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13581 are loaded.
13582
13583 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013584 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13585 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13586 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13587 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13588 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13589 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13590 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013591 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013592
13593 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13594 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13595 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13596 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013597 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13598 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013599
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013600 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013601
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013602 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013603 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013604 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13605 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013606 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13607 clients).
13608
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013609 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013610 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13611 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13612 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13613 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13614 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13615 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13616 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13617 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13618 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13619 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13620 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13621 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13622
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013623 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013624 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13625 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13626 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13627 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13628
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013629 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13630 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13631 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13632 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013633
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013634 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13635 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13636 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013637
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013638crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013639 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013640 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013641 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013642 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013643
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013644crt-list <file>
13645 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013646 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13647 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013648
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013649 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13650
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013651 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13652 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13653 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13654 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13655 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013656
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013657 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013658 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13659 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13660 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13661 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13662 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013663 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13664 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13665 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013666
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013667 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13668 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13669 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013670
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013671 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13672
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013673 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013674 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013675 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13676 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13677 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13678 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13679 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13680 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013681
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013682 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013683 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013684 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013685 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013686 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013687 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013688
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013689defer-accept
13690 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13691 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13692 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013693 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013694 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13695 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13696 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13697 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13698 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13699 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13700 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13701
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013702expose-fd listeners
13703 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13704 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013705 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13706 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013707 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013708
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013709force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013710 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013711 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013712 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013713 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013714
13715force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013716 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013717 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013718 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013719
13720force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013721 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013722 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013723 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013724
13725force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013726 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013727 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013728 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013729
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013730force-tlsv13
13731 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13732 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013733 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013734
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013735generate-certificates
13736 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13737 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13738 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13739 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13740 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13741 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13742 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13743 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13744 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13745 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13746 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13747
13748 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13749 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013750 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013751 certificate is used many times.
13752
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013753gid <gid>
13754 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13755 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13756 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13757 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13758 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13759
13760group <group>
13761 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13762 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13763 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13764 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13765 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13766
13767id <id>
13768 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13769 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13770 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13771 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13772
13773interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013774 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13775 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13776 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13777 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13778 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13779 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013780 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13781 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13782 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13783 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13784 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13785 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013786
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013787level <level>
13788 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13789 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13790 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013791 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013792 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13793 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13794 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013795 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013796 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013797 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013798 all counters).
13799
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013800severity-output <format>
13801 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13802 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13803 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13804 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13805 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13806 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13807 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13808 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13809 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13810 rfc5424 convention.
13811
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013812maxconn <maxconn>
13813 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13814 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13815 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13816 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13817 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13818 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13819 eat all memory.
13820
13821mode <mode>
13822 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13823 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13824 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13825 UNIX sockets.
13826
13827mss <maxseg>
13828 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13829 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13830 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13831 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13832 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13833 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13834 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13835 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13836 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13837 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13838 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13839
13840name <name>
13841 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13842 page.
13843
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013844namespace <name>
13845 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13846 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13847 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13848 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13849
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013850nice <nice>
13851 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13852 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13853 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13854 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13855 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13856 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13857 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13858 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13859 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13860 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13861 one for an RDP socket.
13862
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013863no-ca-names
13864 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13865 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013866 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013867
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013868no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013869 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013870 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013871 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013872 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013873 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13874 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013875
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013876no-tls-tickets
13877 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13878 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13879 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013880 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13881 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013882 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13883 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13884 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013885
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013886no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013887 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013888 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013889 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013890 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013891 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13892 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013893
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013894no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013895 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013896 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013897 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013898 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013899 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13900 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013901
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013902no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013903 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013904 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013905 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013906 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013907 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13908 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013909
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013910no-tlsv13
13911 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13912 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13913 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13914 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013915 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13916 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013917
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013918npn <protocols>
13919 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13920 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13921 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013922 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013923 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013924 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13925 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13926 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13927 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13928 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013929
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013930prefer-client-ciphers
13931 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13932 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13933 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013934 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13935 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13936 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013937
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013938process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020013939 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
13940 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. Note
13941 that only process number 1 is permitted. If a thread set is specified, it
13942 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
13943 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
13944 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013945
13946 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13947
13948 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020013949 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
13950 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
13951 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
13952 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
13953 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013954
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013955proto <name>
13956 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13957 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13958 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013959 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13960 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13961
13962 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13963 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13964 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13965 also reported (flag=HTX).
13966
13967 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13968 a bind line :
13969
13970 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13971 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13972 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13973
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013974 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013975 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013976 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013977 h2" on the bind line.
13978
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013979ssl
13980 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013981 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013982 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13983 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013984 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13985 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013986
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013987ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13988 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013989 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13990 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13991 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013992 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13993
13994ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013995 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13996 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13997 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13998 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013999
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010014000strict-sni
14001 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
14002 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
14003 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
14004 See the "crt" option for more information.
14005
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014006tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014007 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014008 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014009 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014010 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014011 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
14012 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
14013 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
14014 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
14015 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
14016 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
14017 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14018
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014019tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010014020 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014021 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
14022 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
14023 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
14024 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
14025 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
14026 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
14027 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020014028 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
14029 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
14030 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014031
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014032tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
14033 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010014034 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
14035 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
14036 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
14037 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
14038 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
14039 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
14040 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
14041 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
14042 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
14043 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014044 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
14045 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
14046
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014047transparent
14048 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14049 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
14050 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
14051 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
14052 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
14053 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14054 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14055 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14056 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14057 so check for support with your vendor.
14058
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014059v4v6
14060 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14061 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14062 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14063 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014064 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014065
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014066v6only
14067 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14068 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14069 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014070 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14071 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014072
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014073uid <uid>
14074 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14075 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14076 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14077 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14078 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14079
14080user <user>
14081 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14082 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14083 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14084 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14085 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14086
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014087verify [none|optional|required]
14088 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14089 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14090 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14091 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14092 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014093 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14094 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14095 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14096 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014097
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200140985.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014099------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014100
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014101The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14102which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14103arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14104settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14105after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14106Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14107address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014108
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014109 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014110 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014111
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014112Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14113keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14114
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014115The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014116
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014117addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014118 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014119 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14120 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14121 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14122 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14123 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014124
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014125agent-check
14126 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014127 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014128 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14129 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14130 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014131
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014132 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014133 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014134 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014135 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14136 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014137
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014138 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14139 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14140 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14141 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14142 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014143
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014144 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014145 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014146
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014147 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14148 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14149 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014150
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014151 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14152 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14153 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014154
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014155 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014156 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14157 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14158 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14159 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014160 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014161 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014162
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014163 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14164 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014165
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014166 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14167 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14168 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14169 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14170 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14171 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14172 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14173 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14174 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014175
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014176 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14177 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014178 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14179 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14180 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014181 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014182
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014183 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014184 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014185
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014186agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014187 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014188 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14189 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14190 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14191 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14192
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014193agent-inter <delay>
14194 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14195 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14196
14197 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14198 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14199 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14200 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14201 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14202 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14203 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14204 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14205 of backends use the same servers.
14206
14207 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14208
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014209agent-addr <addr>
14210 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14211
14212 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014213 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014214 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14215 hostname, it will be resolved.
14216
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014217agent-port <port>
14218 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14219
14220 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14221
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014222allow-0rtt
14223 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014224 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14225 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014226
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014227alpn <protocols>
14228 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14229 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14230 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014231 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014232 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14233 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14234 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14235 now obsolete NPN extension.
14236 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14237 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14238
14239 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14240
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014241backup
14242 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14243 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14244 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14245 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014246 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14247 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014248
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014249ca-file <cafile>
14250 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14251 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14252 server's certificate.
14253
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014254check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014255 This option enables health checks on a server:
14256 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14257 considered available.
14258 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14259 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14260 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14261 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14262 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14263 set.
14264 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14265 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14266 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14267 exchanges succeed.
14268
14269 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14270 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14271 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14272 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14273 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014274 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014275 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14276
14277 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14278 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14279
14280 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14281 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14282
14283 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14284 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14285 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14286 available.
14287
14288 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14289 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14290 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14291
14292 Example:
14293 # simple tcp check
14294 backend foo
14295 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14296 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14297 backend foo
14298 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14299 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14300 backend foo
14301 option tcp-check
14302 tcp-check connect
14303 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014304
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014305check-send-proxy
14306 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14307 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14308 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14309 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14310 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14311 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14312 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14313
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014314check-alpn <protocols>
14315 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14316 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14317 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14318
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014319check-proto <name>
14320 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14321 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14322 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014323 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14324 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14325
14326 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14327 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14328 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14329 also reported (flag=HTX).
14330
14331 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14332 directive on a server line:
14333
14334 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14335 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14336 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14337 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14338
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014339 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014340 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14341 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14342
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014343check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014344 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014345 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14346 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014347
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014348check-ssl
14349 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14350 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14351 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14352 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014353 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014354 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14355 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014356 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014357 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14358 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014359
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014360check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014361 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014362 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14363 for normal traffic.
14364
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014365ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014366 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14367 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14368 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014369 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14370 information and recommendations see e.g.
14371 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14372 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14373 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014374
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014375ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14376 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14377 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14378 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14379 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014380 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14381 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14382 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014383
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014384cookie <value>
14385 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14386 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14387 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14388 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14389 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14390 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14391 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14392
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014393crl-file <crlfile>
14394 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14395 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14396 to verify server's certificate.
14397
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014398crt <cert>
14399 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14400 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14401 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14402 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14403 certificate request.
14404
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014405 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14406 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14407 option is set accordingly).
14408
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014409disabled
14410 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14411 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14412 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14413 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14414 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014415 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014416
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014417enabled
14418 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14419 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14420 default value.
14421 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14422 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014423
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014424error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014425 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14426 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14427 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014428
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014429 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014430
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014431fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014432 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14433 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14434 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14435
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014436force-sslv3
14437 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14438 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014439 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014440 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014441
14442force-tlsv10
14443 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014444 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014445 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014446
14447force-tlsv11
14448 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014449 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014450 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014451
14452force-tlsv12
14453 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014454 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014455 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014456
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014457force-tlsv13
14458 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14459 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014460 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014461
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014462id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014463 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14464 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14465 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014466
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014467init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14468 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14469 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014470 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014471 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14472 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14473 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14474 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14475 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14476 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14477 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14478 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14479 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014480 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014481 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14482 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14483 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14484 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14485 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14486 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014487 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014488
14489 Example:
14490 defaults
14491 # never fail on address resolution
14492 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14493
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014494inter <delay>
14495fastinter <delay>
14496downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014497 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14498 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14499 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14500 between checks depending on the server state :
14501
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014502 Server state | Interval used
14503 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14504 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14505 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14506 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14507 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14508 or yet unchecked. |
14509 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14510 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14511 | "inter" otherwise.
14512 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014514 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14515 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14516 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14517 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014518 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14519 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14520 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14521 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14522 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014523
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014524log-proto <logproto>
14525 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14526 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14527 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14528 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14529
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014530maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014531 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14532 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014533 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14534 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014535 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14536 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14537 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14538 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14539
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014540 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14541 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14542 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14543 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14544 than 50 concurrent requests.
14545
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014546maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014547 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14548 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14549 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14550 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014551 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14552 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14553 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14554 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14555 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14556 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14557 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014558
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014559max-reuse <count>
14560 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14561 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14562 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14563 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14564 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14565 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14566 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14567 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14568
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014569minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014570 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14571 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14572 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14573 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14574 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14575 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014576 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014577 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014578
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014579namespace <name>
14580 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14581 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14582 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14583 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14584
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014585no-agent-check
14586 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14587 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14588 default value.
14589 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14590 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14591
14592no-backup
14593 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14594 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14595 default value.
14596 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14597 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14598
14599no-check
14600 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14601 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14602 default value.
14603 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14604 "default-server" "check" setting.
14605
14606no-check-ssl
14607 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14608 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14609 default value.
14610 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14611 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14612
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014613no-send-proxy
14614 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14615 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14616 default value.
14617 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14618 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14619
14620no-send-proxy-v2
14621 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14622 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14623 default value.
14624 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14625 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14626
14627no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14628 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14629 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14630 default value.
14631 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14632 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14633
14634no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14635 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14636 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14637 default value.
14638 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14639 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14640
14641no-ssl
14642 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14643 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14644 default value.
14645 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14646 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14647
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014648 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14649 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14650 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14651
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014652no-ssl-reuse
14653 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14654 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14655 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14656 and for paranoid users.
14657
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014658no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014659 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14660 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014661 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014662
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014663 Supported in default-server: No
14664
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014665no-tls-tickets
14666 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14667 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14668 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014669 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14670 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014671 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14672 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14673 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014674 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014675
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014676no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014677 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014678 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14679 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014680 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14681 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014682 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014683
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014684 Supported in default-server: No
14685
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014686no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014687 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014688 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14689 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014690 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14691 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014692 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014693
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014694 Supported in default-server: No
14695
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014696no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014697 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014698 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14699 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014700 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14701 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014702 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014703
14704 Supported in default-server: No
14705
14706no-tlsv13
14707 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14708 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14709 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14710 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14711 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014712 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014713
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014714 Supported in default-server: No
14715
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014716no-verifyhost
14717 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14718 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14719 default value.
14720 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14721 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014722
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014723no-tfo
14724 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14725 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14726 default value.
14727 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14728 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14729
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014730non-stick
14731 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14732 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14733 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14734
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014735npn <protocols>
14736 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14737 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14738 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014739 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014740 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14741 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14742 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14743
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014744observe <mode>
14745 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14746 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14747 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14748 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14749 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14750 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014751 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014752
14753 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14754
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014755on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014756 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14757 Currently, four modes are available:
14758 - fastinter: force fastinter
14759 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14760 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14761 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14762 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14763
14764 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14765
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014766on-marked-down <action>
14767 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14768 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014769 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14770 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14771 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14772 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14773 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14774 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14775 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14776 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014777
14778 Actions are disabled by default
14779
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014780on-marked-up <action>
14781 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14782 Currently one action is available:
14783 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14784 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14785 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14786 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014787 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14788 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014789 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14790 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14791
14792 Actions are disabled by default
14793
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014794pool-low-conn <max>
14795 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14796 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14797 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14798 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14799 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14800 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14801 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14802 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14803 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14804 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014805 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14806 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14807 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14808 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014809
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014810pool-max-conn <max>
14811 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14812 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14813 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14814 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14815 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14816 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14817
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014818pool-purge-delay <delay>
14819 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014820 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014821 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014822
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014823port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014824 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014825 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14826 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14827 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14828 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14829 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014830
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014831proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014832 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14833 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14834 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014835 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14836 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14837
14838 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14839 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14840 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14841 also reported (flag=HTX).
14842
14843 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14844 a server line :
14845
14846 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14847 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14848 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14849 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14850
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014851 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014852 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14853
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014854redir <prefix>
14855 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14856 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14857 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14858 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14859 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14860 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14861 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14862 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014863 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014864 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014865 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14866 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14867 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14868 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14869
14870 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14871
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014872rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014873 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14874 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14875 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14876
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014877resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14878 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14879 server.
14880
14881 Available options:
14882
14883 * allow-dup-ip
14884 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14885 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14886 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14887 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14888 For such case, simply enable this option.
14889 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14890
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014891 * ignore-weight
14892 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14893 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14894 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14895
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014896 * prevent-dup-ip
14897 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14898 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14899 same fqdn.
14900 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14901
14902 Example:
14903 backend b_myapp
14904 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14905 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14906 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14907
14908 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14909 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14910 it
14911 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14912 different address
14913
14914 Default value: not set
14915
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014916resolve-prefer <family>
14917 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14918 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14919 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14920 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14921
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014922 Default value: ipv6
14923
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014924 Example:
14925
14926 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014927
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014928resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014929 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014930 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014931 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014932 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14933 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014934 configured network, another address is selected.
14935
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014936 Example:
14937
14938 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014939
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014940resolvers <id>
14941 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14942 hostname.
14943
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014944 Example:
14945
14946 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014947
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014948 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014949
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014950send-proxy
14951 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14952 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14953 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14954 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014955 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14956 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14957 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14958 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014959 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014960 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14961 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14962 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14963 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14964 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014965 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14966 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014967
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014968send-proxy-v2
14969 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14970 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14971 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14972 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014973 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14974 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14975 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14976 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014977
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014978proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014979 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14980 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14981
14982 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14983 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14984 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14985 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14986 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14987 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14988 connection is supported).
14989 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14990 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14991 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14992 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14993 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14994 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14995 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014996
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014997send-proxy-v2-ssl
14998 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14999 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15000 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15001 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15002 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15003 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
15004 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015005 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
15006 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015007
15008send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15009 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15010 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15011 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15012 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15013 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15014 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
15015 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
15016 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015017 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
15018 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015019
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015020slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015021 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
15022 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
15023 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
15024 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
15025 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
15026 parameters :
15027
15028 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
15029 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
15030
15031 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
15032 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
15033 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
15034 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
15035
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015036 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015037 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
15038 seen as failed.
15039
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015040sni <expression>
15041 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
15042 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
15043 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
15044 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020015045 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
15046 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015047 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010015048 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
15049 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015050
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015051source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020015052source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015053source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015054 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15055 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15056 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15057 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15058
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015059 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15060 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15061 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15062 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15063 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15064 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15065 server.
15066
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015067 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15068 specifying the source address without port(s).
15069
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015070ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015071 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15072 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15073 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15074 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15075 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15076 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015077 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15078 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015079
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015080ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15081 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15082 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15083 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15084
15085ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15086 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15087 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15088 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15089
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015090ssl-reuse
15091 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15092 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15093 default value.
15094 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15095 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15096
15097stick
15098 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15099 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15100 default value.
15101 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15102 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015103
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015104socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015105 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015106 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15107 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15108
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015109tcp-ut <delay>
15110 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015111 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015112 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015113 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015114 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15115 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15116 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15117 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15118 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15119 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15120 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15121 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15122 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15123
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015124tfo
15125 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15126 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15127 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15128 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015129 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015130 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015131
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015132track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015133 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15134 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15135 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15136 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015137 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15138
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015139tls-tickets
15140 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15141 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15142 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015143 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15144 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15145 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015146 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015147 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015148
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015149verify [none|required]
15150 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015151 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015152 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15153 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015154 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015155 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15156 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15157 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15158 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15159 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15160 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15161 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15162 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015163
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015164verifyhost <hostname>
15165 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015166 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15167 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15168 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15169 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15170 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15171 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15172 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15173 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015174
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015175weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015176 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15177 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15178 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015179 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15180 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15181 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15182 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15183 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15184 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015185
15186
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151875.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15188-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015189
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015190HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15191using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015192configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015193This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15194can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15195workload.
15196This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15197resolution at run time.
15198Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15199carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15200
15201
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152025.3.1. Global overview
15203----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015204
15205As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15206different steps of the process life:
15207
15208 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15209 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15210 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15211
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015212 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15213 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015214
15215A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15216 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15217 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15218 resolution to know this new IP.
15219
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015220When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015221HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015222SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15223from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015224will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015225will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015226
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015227A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015228 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015229 first valid response.
15230
15231 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15232 servers return an error.
15233
15234
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152355.3.2. The resolvers section
15236----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015237
15238This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015239HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15240contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015241
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015242When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15243uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15244is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15245answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15246
15247When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015248used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015249
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015250 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15251 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15252 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015253
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015254 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15255 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015256
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015257 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
15258 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15259 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015260
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015261For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15262following scenarios are possible:
15263
15264 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15265 ignored
15266
15267 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15268 applied
15269
15270 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15271 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15272
15273 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15274 retries the query with a new type
15275
15276 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15277 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015278
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015279As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015280a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015281<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015282
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015283
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015284resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015285 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015286
15287A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15288
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015289accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015290 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015291 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015292 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15293 by RFC 6891)
15294
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015295 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15296 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15297 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15298 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15299 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15300 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015301
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015302nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15303 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15304 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15305 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15306 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15307 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15308 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15309 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15310 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15311 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015312 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15313
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015314parse-resolv-conf
15315 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15316 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15317 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15318
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015319hold <status> <period>
15320 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15321 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015322 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015323 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015324 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15325 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15326 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15327
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015328 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015329
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015330resolve_retries <nb>
15331 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15332 giving up.
15333 Default value: 3
15334
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015335 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15336 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15337 type.
15338
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015339timeout <event> <time>
15340 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15341 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15342 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015343 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15344 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015345 Default value: 1s
15346 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015347 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015348 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015349 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15350 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15351
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015352 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015353
15354 resolvers mydns
15355 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15356 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015357 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015358 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015359 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015360 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015361 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015362 hold other 30s
15363 hold refused 30s
15364 hold nx 30s
15365 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015366 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015367 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015368
15369
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200153706. Cache
15371---------
15372
15373HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15374(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15375RAM.
15376
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020015377The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
15378blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015379
15380If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15381independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15382when we try to allocate a new one.
15383
15384The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15385
15386It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15387"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15388for more details.
15389
15390When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15391replaced by "<CACHE>".
15392
15393
153946.1. Limitation
15395----------------
15396
15397The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15398
15399- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015400- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15401 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15402 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015403- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15404- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015405- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15406 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15407 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015408- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15409 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015410- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15411 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15412 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015413
15414- If the request is not a GET
15415- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15416- If the request contains an Authorization header
15417
15418
154196.2. Setup
15420-----------
15421
15422To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15423the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15424
15425
154266.2.1. Cache section
15427---------------------
15428
15429cache <name>
15430 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15431 size of cache is mandatory.
15432
15433total-max-size <megabytes>
15434 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15435 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15436
15437max-object-size <bytes>
15438 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15439 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15440 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15441
15442max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015443 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015444 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15445 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15446 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15447 default.
15448
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015449process-vary <on/off>
15450 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015451 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15452 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15453 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015454 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015455
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015456max-secondary-entries <number>
15457 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15458 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15459 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15460
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015461
154626.2.2. Proxy section
15463---------------------
15464
15465http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15466 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15467 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15468 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15469 after this one.
15470
15471http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15472 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15473 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15474 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15475 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15476
15477
15478Example:
15479
15480 backend bck1
15481 mode http
15482
15483 http-request cache-use foobar
15484 http-response cache-store foobar
15485 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15486
15487 cache foobar
15488 total-max-size 4
15489 max-age 240
15490
15491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154927. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15493----------------------------------
15494
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015495HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015496client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15497The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15498these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15499but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15500data called patterns.
15501
15502
155037.1. ACL basics
15504---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015505
15506The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15507content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15508from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15509simple :
15510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015511 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015512 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015513 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15514 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015516The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15517adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015518
15519In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015521 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015522
15523This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15524Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15525and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015526an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15527conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15528as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15529are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015530
15531ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15532'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15533which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15534
15535There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15536performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015538The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15539specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15540this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015541methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15542ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015543
15544Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15545 - boolean
15546 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15547 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15548 - string
15549 - data block
15550
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015551Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15552converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15553would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15554The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15555which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15556
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015557Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15558keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15559fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15560which are summarized in the table below :
15561
15562 +---------------------+-----------------+
15563 | Sample or converter | Default |
15564 | output type | matching method |
15565 +---------------------+-----------------+
15566 | boolean | bool |
15567 +---------------------+-----------------+
15568 | integer | int |
15569 +---------------------+-----------------+
15570 | ip | ip |
15571 +---------------------+-----------------+
15572 | string | str |
15573 +---------------------+-----------------+
15574 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15575 +---------------------+-----------------+
15576
15577Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15578matching method, see below.
15579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015580The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15581 - boolean
15582 - integer or integer range
15583 - IP address / network
15584 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15585 - regular expression
15586 - hex block
15587
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015588The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15589
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015590 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15591 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015592 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015593 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015594 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015595 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015596 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015598The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15599read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15600if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15601lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15602will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15603beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015604a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015605lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15606exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15607
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015608The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15609parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15610ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15611a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15612check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15613
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015614The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15615socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15616file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015618Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15619loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15620
15621 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15622
15623In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15624the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15625case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15626as well.
15627
15628The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15629sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15630do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15631methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15632is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015633obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015634followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15635default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15636that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15637string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15638
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015639The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15640By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15641string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15642resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015643server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015644waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015645flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15646function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015648There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15649sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15650be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015651
15652 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15653 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015654 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15655 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15656 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15657 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015658
15659 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15660 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015661 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015662
15663 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015664 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015665
15666 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015667 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015668
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015669 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015670 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15671
15672 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15673 binary or string samples.
15674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015675 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15676 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015678 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15679 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15680 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015682 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15683 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015685 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15686 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015688 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15689 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015691 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15692 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015693 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015695 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15696 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15697 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015698
15699For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15700request, it is possible to do :
15701
15702 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15703
15704In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15705buffer, one would use the following acl :
15706
15707 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15708
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015709On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15710possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15711
15712 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015714All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15715criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15716method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15717to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15718criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15719the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015721If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015722the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15723For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015725 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15726 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15727 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15728 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015729
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015730
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015731The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15732types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15733combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15734brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15735default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015737 +-------------------------------------------------+
15738 | Input sample type |
15739 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015740 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015741 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15742 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15743 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015744 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015745 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015746 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015747 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015748 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015749 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015750 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015751 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015752 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015753 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015754 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015755 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015756 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015757 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015758 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015759 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015760 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015761 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015762 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015763 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015764 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015765 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15766 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15767 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015768
15769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157707.1.1. Matching booleans
15771------------------------
15772
15773In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15774Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15775When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15776that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15777
15778Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15779return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15780"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15781
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157837.1.2. Matching integers
15784------------------------
15785
15786Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15787enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15788to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15789
15790Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15791matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15792lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015793
15794For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15795unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15796representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15797
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015798As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15799two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15800instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15801ranges and operators.
15802
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015803For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015804operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15805Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15806of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015807
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015808Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015809
15810 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15811 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15812 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15813 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15814 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15815
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015816For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015817
15818 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15819
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015820This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15821
15822 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15823
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158257.1.3. Matching strings
15826-----------------------
15827
15828String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15829different forms :
15830
15831 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015832 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015833
15834 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015835 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015836
15837 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15838 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15839
15840 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15841 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15842
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015843 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015844 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15845 matches.
15846
15847 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15848 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15849 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015850
15851String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15852exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15853characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15854string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15855to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015856before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015857
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015858Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15859(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15860Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15861
15862Example:
15863 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15864 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15865
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15868---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015869
15870Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15871they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15872possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15873passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15874the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015875the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15876match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015877
15878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158797.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15880-------------------------------------
15881
15882It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15883not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15884a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15885to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15886digits may be used upper or lower case.
15887
15888Example :
15889 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15890 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15891
15892
158937.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15894---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015895
15896IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15897netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15898within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015899host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015900difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15901at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15902does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15903parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015904
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015905The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15906abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15907
15908 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15909 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15910 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15911 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15912 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15913 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15914 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15915 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15916
15917Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15918192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15919
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015920IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15921Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15922trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15923IPv6 patterns.
15924
15925HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15926following situations :
15927 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15928 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15929 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15930 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15931 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15932 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15933 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15934 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15935 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15936 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015938
159397.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15940----------------------------------
15941
15942Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15943combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15944
15945 - AND (implicit)
15946 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15947 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015949A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015951 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015953Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15954indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015956For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15957"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15958requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15959is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15960
15961 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015962 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15963 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15964 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015965
15966To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15967and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15968
15969 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15970 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15971 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15972 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15973
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015974 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015975 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15976 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15977 use_backend www if host_www
15978
15979It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15980expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15981be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15982the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15983
15984 The following rule :
15985
15986 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015987 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015988
15989 Can also be written that way :
15990
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015991 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015992
15993It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15994to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15995simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15996sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15997good use is the following :
15998
15999 With named ACLs :
16000
16001 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
16002 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
16003 monitor fail if site_dead
16004
16005 With anonymous ACLs :
16006
16007 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
16008
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016009See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
16010keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016011
16012
160137.3. Fetching samples
16014---------------------
16015
16016Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
16017against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
16018sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
16019ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
16020of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
16021available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
16022
16023This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
16024Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
16025compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
16026deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
16027
16028The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
16029matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
16030method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
16031indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
16032
16033As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
16034when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
16035mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
16036the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
16037ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
16038
16039Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
16040multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
16041when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016042incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
16043are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016044is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16045all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16046
16047Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16048 - name
16049 - name(arg1)
16050 - name(arg1,arg2)
16051
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016052
160537.3.1. Converters
16054-----------------
16055
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016056Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16057of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16058is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16059was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016060has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016061unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16062
16063These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16064sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16065the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016066support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016067
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016068A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16069support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16070supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16071(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16072bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016074The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016075
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001607651d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16077 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16078 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16079 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16080 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16081 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16082
16083 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016084 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16085 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016086 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16087 frontend http-in
16088 bind *:8081
16089 default_backend servers
16090 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16091 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16092
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016093add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016094 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016095 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016096 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16097 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016098 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016099 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16100 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16101 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16102 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016103 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016104 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016105
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016106aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16107 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16108 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16109 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16110 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16111 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16112 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16113
16114 Example:
16115 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16116 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16117
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016118and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016119 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016120 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016121 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16122 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016123 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016124 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16125 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16126 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16127 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016128 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016129 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016130
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016131b64dec
16132 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16133 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016134 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16135 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016136
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016137base64
16138 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016139 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016140 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16141 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016142
Marcin Deranek40ca09c2021-07-13 14:05:24 +020016143be2dec(<separator>,<chunk_size>,[<truncate>])
16144 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a string containing an unsigned
16145 integer number per <chunk_size> input bytes. <separator> is put every
16146 <chunk_size> binary input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates
16147 whatever binary input is truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries. <chunk_size>
16148 maximum value is limited by the size of long long int (8 bytes).
16149
16150 Example:
16151 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(:,2) # 258:772:1286:7
16152 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(-,2,1) # 258-772-1286
16153 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(,2,1) # 2587721286
16154 bin(7f000001),be2dec(.,1) # 127.0.0.1
16155
Marcin Deranekda0264a2021-07-13 14:08:56 +020016156be2hex([<separator>],[<chunk_size>],[<truncate>])
16157 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex
16158 digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some
16159 binary input data in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID
16160 can be copied in a header). <separator> is put every <chunk_size> binary
16161 input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates whatever binary input is
16162 truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries.
16163
16164 Example:
16165 bin(01020304050607),be2hex # 01020304050607
16166 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(:,2) # 0102:0304:0506:07
16167 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(--,2,1) # 0102--0304--0506
16168 bin(0102030405060708),be2hex(,3,1) # 010203040506
16169
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016170bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016171 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016172 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016173 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016174 presence of a flag).
16175
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016176bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16177 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16178 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016179 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016180
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016181concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16182 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16183 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16184 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16185 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16186 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16187 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16188 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16189 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16190 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16191 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016192 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016193 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016194 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020016195 level parser. This is often used to build composite variables from other
16196 ones, but sometimes using a format string with multiple fields may be more
16197 convenient. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016198
16199 Example:
16200 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16201 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16202 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016203 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020016204 tcp-request session set-var-fmt(txn.ipport) "addr=(%[sess.ip],%[sess.port])" ## does the same
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016205 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16206
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016207cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016208 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16209 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016210
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016211crc32([<avalanche>])
16212 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16213 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16214 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16215 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16216 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16217 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16218 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16219 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16220 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16221 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016222 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16223
16224crc32c([<avalanche>])
16225 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16226 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16227 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16228 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16229 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16230 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16231 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16232 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016233
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016234cut_crlf
16235 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16236 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16237 updated.
16238
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016239da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016240 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16241 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16242 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16243 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016244 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016245 configuration language.
16246
16247 Example:
16248 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016249 bind *:8881
16250 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016251 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016252
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016253debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16254 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16255 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16256 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16257 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16258 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16259 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16260 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16261 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16262 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16263 printable sample types.
16264
16265 Example:
16266 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016267
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016268digest(<algorithm>)
16269 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16270 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16271
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016272 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016273 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16274
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016275div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016276 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16277 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016278 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016279 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16280 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016281 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016282 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16283 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16284 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16285 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016286 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016287 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016288
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016289djb2([<avalanche>])
16290 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16291 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16292 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16293 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16294 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16295 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16296 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016297 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16298 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016299
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016300even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016301 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016302 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16303
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016304field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16305 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16306 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16307 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16308 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16309 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16310 fields.
16311
16312 Example :
16313 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16314 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16315 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16316 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16317 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016318
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016319fix_is_valid
16320 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16321 Information eXchange):
16322
16323 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16324 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016325 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016326 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016327 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016328 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16329 checksum
16330
16331 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16332 the server can be parsed.
16333
16334 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16335 message, false if not.
16336
16337 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16338
16339 Example:
16340 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16341 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16342
16343fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16344 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16345 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16346 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16347 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016348 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016349 added.
16350
16351 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16352 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16353 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16354 fix_is_valid converter.
16355
16356 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16357
16358 Example:
16359 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16360 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16361 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16362 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16363 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16364
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016365hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016366 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016367 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016368 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016369 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016370
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016371hex2i
16372 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016373 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016374
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016375htonl
16376 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16377 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16378 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16379 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16380
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016381hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016382 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16383 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16384 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16385 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16386
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016387 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016388 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16389
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016390http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016391 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16392 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016393 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16394 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16395 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16396 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16397 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16398 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16399 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16400 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016401
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016402iif(<true>,<false>)
16403 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16404 string otherwise.
16405
16406 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016407 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016408
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016409in_table(<table>)
16410 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16411 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16412 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016413 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016414 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16415
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016416ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016417 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016418 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016419 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16420 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16421 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16422 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16423 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016424
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016425json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016426 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016427 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016428 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016429 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16430 of errors:
16431 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16432 bytes, ...)
16433 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16434 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16435
16436 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16437 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16438 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16439 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16440 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16441 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016442 - "ascii" : never fails;
16443 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16444 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016445 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016446 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016447 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16448 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16449
16450 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016451 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016452
16453 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016454 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016455 capture request header user-agent len 150
16456 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016457
16458 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16459 GET / HTTP/1.0
16460 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16461
16462 Output log:
16463 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16464
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016465json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16466 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16467 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16468 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16469 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16470
16471 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16472 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16473
16474 Example:
16475 # get a integer value from the request body
16476 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16477 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16478
16479 # get a key with '.' in the name
16480 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16481 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16482
16483 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16484 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16485
16486 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16487 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16488
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016489language(<value>[,<default>])
16490 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16491 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16492 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16493 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16494 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16495 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16496 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16497 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16498 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016499 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016500 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16501 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016502
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016503 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016504
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016505 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16506 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016507
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016508 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16509 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16510 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16511 use_backend spanish if es
16512 use_backend french if fr
16513 use_backend english if en
16514 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016515
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016516length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016517 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16518 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16519 type. The result is of type integer.
16520
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016521lower
16522 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16523 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16524 type. The result is of type string.
16525
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016526ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16527 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16528 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16529 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16530 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16531 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16532 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16533
16534 Example :
16535
16536 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016537 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016538 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16539
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016540ltrim(<chars>)
16541 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16542 representation of the input sample.
16543
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016544map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16545map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16546map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16547 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16548 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16549 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16550 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16551 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16552 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16553 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16554 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016555
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016556 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16557 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16558 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016559
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016560 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016561 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016562
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016563 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16564 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16565 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16566 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016567 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16568 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016569 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16570 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16571 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16572 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16573 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16574 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16575 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16576 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016577 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16578 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16579 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016580 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16581 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16582 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16583 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16584 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016585
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016586 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16587 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16588 the corresponding match text.
16589
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016590 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16591 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16592 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16593 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16594 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016595
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016596 Example :
16597
16598 # this is a comment and is ignored
16599 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16600 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16601 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16602 | | | `---------- value
16603 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16604 | `---------------------------- key
16605 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16606
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016607mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016608 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16609 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016610 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016611 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016612 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016613 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16614 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16615 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16616 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016617 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016618 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016619
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016620mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016621 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16622 <packettype>.
16623 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16624 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16625 from.
16626 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16627 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16628 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16629
16630 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16631 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16632 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16633 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16634
16635 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16636 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16637 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16638 packets only):
16639 17: Session Expiry Interval
16640 33: Receive Maximum
16641 39: Maximum Packet Size
16642 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16643 25: Request Response Information
16644 23: Request Problem Information
16645 21: Authentication Method
16646 22: Authentication Data
16647 18: Will Delay Interval
16648 1: Payload Format Indicator
16649 2: Message Expiry Interval
16650 3: Content Type
16651 8: Response Topic
16652 9: Correlation Data
16653 Not supported yet:
16654 38: User Property
16655
16656 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16657 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16658 packets only):
16659 17: Session Expiry Interval
16660 33: Receive Maximum
16661 36: Maximum QoS
16662 37: Retain Available
16663 39: Maximum Packet Size
16664 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16665 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16666 31: Reason String
16667 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16668 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16669 42: Shared Subscription Available
16670 19: Server Keep Alive
16671 26: Response Information
16672 28: Server Reference
16673 21: Authentication Method
16674 22: Authentication Data
16675 Not supported yet:
16676 38: User Property
16677
16678 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16679 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16680 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16681 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16682
16683 Example:
16684
16685 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16686 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16687 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16688 if data_in_buffer
16689 # do the same as above
16690 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16691 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16692 if data_in_buffer
16693
16694mqtt_is_valid
16695 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16696
16697 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16698 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16699 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16700 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16701
16702 Example:
16703
16704 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016705 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016706
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016707mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016708 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016709 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16710 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016711 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016712 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016713 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016714 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16715 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16716 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16717 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016718 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016719 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016720
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016721nbsrv
16722 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16723 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16724 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16725 map lookup.
16726
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016727neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016728 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16729 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16730 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16731 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016732
16733not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016734 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016735 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016736 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016737 absence of a flag).
16738
16739odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016740 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016741 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16742
16743or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016744 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016745 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016746 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16747 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016748 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016749 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16750 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16751 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16752 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016753 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016754 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016755
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016756protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16757 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16758 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16759 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16760 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16761 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16762 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16763 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16764 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16765 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16766 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16767 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16768
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016769regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016770 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16771 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16772 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16773 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16774 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16775 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16776 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16777 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16778 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016779 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16780 of characters with other ones.
16781
16782 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16783 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16784 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16785 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16786 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16787 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016788
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016789 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016790
16791 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16792 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16793 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016794 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016795
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016796 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16797 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16798
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016799 # capture groups and backreferences
16800 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016801 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016802 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16803
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016804capture-req(<id>)
16805 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16806 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16807
16808 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016809 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16810 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016811
16812capture-res(<id>)
16813 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16814 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16815
16816 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016817 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16818 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016819
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016820rtrim(<chars>)
16821 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16822 of the input sample.
16823
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016824sdbm([<avalanche>])
16825 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16826 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16827 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16828 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16829 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16830 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16831 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016832 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16833 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016834
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016835secure_memcmp(<var>)
16836 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16837 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16838 match.
16839
16840 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16841 performed in constant time.
16842
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016843 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016844 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16845
16846 Example :
16847
16848 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16849 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16850 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16851 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16852
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016853set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016854 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16855 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16856 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016857 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016858 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16859 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016860 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016861 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16862 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016863 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016864 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016865
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016866sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016867 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016868 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16869
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016870sha2([<bits>])
16871 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16872 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16873
16874 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16875 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16876
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016877 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016878 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16879
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016880srv_queue
16881 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16882 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16883 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16884 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16885 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16886
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016887strcmp(<var>)
16888 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16889 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16890 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16891 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16892 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16893 shorter).
16894
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016895 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16896 strings in constant time.
16897
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016898 Example :
16899
16900 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16901 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16902 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16903
16904
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016905sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016906 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16907 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016908 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016909 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16910 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016911 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016912 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16913 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016914 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016915 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16916 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016917 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016918 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016919
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016920table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16921 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16922 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16923 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16924 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16925 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16926 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16927
16928
16929table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16930 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16931 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16932 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16933 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16934 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16935 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16936
16937table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16938 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16939 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016940 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016941 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16942 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16943
16944table_conn_cur(<table>)
16945 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16946 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16947 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16948 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16949 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16950
16951table_conn_rate(<table>)
16952 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16953 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16954 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16955 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16956 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16957
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020016958table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
16959 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
16960 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16961 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
16962 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
16963 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
16964 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
16965 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
16966 data-type).
16967 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
16968
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016969table_gpt0(<table>)
16970 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16971 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16972 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16973 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16974 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16975
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020016976table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
16977 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
16978 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16979 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
16980 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
16981 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
16982 between 0 and 99.
16983 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
16984 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
16985 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
16986 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
16987
16988table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
16989 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
16990 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16991 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
16992 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
16993 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
16994 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
16995 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
16996 value 0.
16997 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
16998 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
16999 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
17000
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017001table_gpc0(<table>)
17002 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17003 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17004 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17005 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17006 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
17007
17008table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
17009 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17010 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17011 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
17012 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17013 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
17014 sample fetch keyword.
17015
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017016table_gpc1(<table>)
17017 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17018 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17019 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
17020 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17021 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
17022
17023table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
17024 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17025 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17026 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
17027 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17028 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
17029 sample fetch keyword.
17030
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017031table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
17032 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17033 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017034 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017035 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17036 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17037
17038table_http_err_rate(<table>)
17039 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17040 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17041 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
17042 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
17043 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
17044 keyword.
17045
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017046table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
17047 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17048 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17049 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
17050 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17051 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17052
17053table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
17054 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17055 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17056 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
17057 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
17058 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
17059 keyword.
17060
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017061table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
17062 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17063 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017064 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017065 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17066 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17067
17068table_http_req_rate(<table>)
17069 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17070 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17071 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
17072 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
17073 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
17074 keyword.
17075
17076table_kbytes_in(<table>)
17077 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17078 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017079 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017080 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17081 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17082 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
17083 keyword.
17084
17085table_kbytes_out(<table>)
17086 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17087 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017088 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017089 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17090 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17091 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
17092 keyword.
17093
17094table_server_id(<table>)
17095 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17096 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17097 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17098 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17099 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17100 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17101
17102table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17103 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17104 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017105 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017106 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17107 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17108 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17109 keyword.
17110
17111table_sess_rate(<table>)
17112 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17113 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17114 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17115 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17116 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17117 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17118 keyword.
17119
17120table_trackers(<table>)
17121 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17122 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17123 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17124 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17125 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17126 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17127 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17128 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17129 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17130 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17131
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017132ub64dec
17133 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17134 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17135 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17136
17137 Example:
17138 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17139 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17140
17141ub64enc
17142 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17143
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017144upper
17145 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17146 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17147 type. The result is of type string.
17148
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017149url_dec([<in_form>])
17150 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17151 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17152 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17153 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17154 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17155 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017156
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017157url_enc([<enc_type>])
17158 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17159 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17160 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17161 optional argument is here for future changes.
17162
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017163ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017164 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017165 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17166 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17167 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017168 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17169 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17170 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17171 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017172 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017173 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17174 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017175
17176 Example:
17177 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17178 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17179
17180 message Point {
17181 int32 latitude = 1;
17182 int32 longitude = 2;
17183 }
17184
17185 message PPoint {
17186 Point point = 59;
17187 }
17188
17189 message Rectangle {
17190 // One corner of the rectangle.
17191 PPoint lo = 48;
17192 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17193 PPoint hi = 49;
17194 }
17195
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017196 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17197 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17198 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017199
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017200 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17201 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017202 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017203 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17204
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017205 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017206
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017207 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017208
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017209 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17210 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17211 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017212
17213 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17214 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17215 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17216
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017217 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17218 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17219 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017220
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017221
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017222unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017223 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17224 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17225 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17226 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17227 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17228 response),
17229 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17230 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17231 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17232 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17233
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017234utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17235 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17236 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17237 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17238 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17239 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17240 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17241
17242 Example :
17243
17244 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017245 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017246 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17247
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017248word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17249 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17250 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17251 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017252 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017253 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17254 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17255
17256 Example :
17257 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17258 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17259 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17260 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17261 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017262 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017263
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017264wt6([<avalanche>])
17265 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17266 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17267 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17268 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17269 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17270 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17271 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017272 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17273 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017274
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017275xor(<value>)
17276 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017277 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017278 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017279 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017280 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017281 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17282 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017283 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017284 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17285 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017286 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017287 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017288
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017289xxh3([<seed>])
17290 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17291 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17292 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17293 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17294 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17295 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17296 considered as cryptographically secure.
17297
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017298xxh32([<seed>])
17299 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17300 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17301 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17302 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17303 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17304 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17305 as cryptographically secure.
17306
17307xxh64([<seed>])
17308 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17309 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17310 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17311 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17312 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17313 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17314 as cryptographically secure.
17315
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017316
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200173177.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017318--------------------------------------------
17319
17320A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17321not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17322"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17323The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17324
17325always_false : boolean
17326 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17327 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17328
17329always_true : boolean
17330 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17331 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17332
17333avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017334 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017335 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17336 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17337 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17338 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17339 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17340 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17341 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17342 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17343 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17344 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17345 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17346 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17347 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017349be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017350 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17351 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17352 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17353 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017354 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17355
17356be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17357 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17358 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17359 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17360 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17361 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017362 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17363 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017364
17365 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17366 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17367 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017369be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17370 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17371 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17372 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017373 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017374 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17375 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017376
17377 Example :
17378 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17379 backend dynamic
17380 mode http
17381 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17382 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017383
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017384bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017385 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17386 of the string.
17387
17388bool(<bool>) : bool
17389 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17390 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017392connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17393 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017394 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017395 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17396 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017397
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017398 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017399 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017400 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17401
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017402 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17403 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017404
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017405 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017406 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017407 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017408 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017409 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017410 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017411 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017412
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017413 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17414 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017415 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017416 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017417
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017418cpu_calls : integer
17419 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17420 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17421 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17422 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17423 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17424 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17425
17426cpu_ns_avg : integer
17427 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17428 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17429 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17430 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17431 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17432 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17433 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17434 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17435 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17436 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17437 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17438
17439cpu_ns_tot : integer
17440 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17441 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17442 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17443 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17444 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17445 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17446 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17447 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17448 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17449 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17450 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17451 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17452 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17453
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017454date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017455 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017456
17457 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17458 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17459 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017460 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17461
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017462 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17463 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17464 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17465 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17466 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17467
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017468 Example :
17469
17470 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17471 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017472
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017473 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17474 # millisecond granularity
17475 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17476
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017477date_us : integer
17478 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17479 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17480 from the same timeval structure.
17481
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017482distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17483 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17484 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17485 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17486 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017487 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017488 list of supported tokens.
17489
17490distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17491 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17492 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17493 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17494 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017495 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017496 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17497 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17498 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17499 supported tokens.
17500
17501 Example :
17502 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17503 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17504 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17505 # send large files to the big farm
17506 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17507
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017508env(<name>) : string
17509 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17510 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17511 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17512 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17513 certain way.
17514
17515 Examples :
17516 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17517 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17518
17519 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
17520 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
17521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017522fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17523 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017524 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17525 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017526 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17527 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017528 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017529 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17530 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017531
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017532fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17533 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17534 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17535 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017537fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17538 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17539 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17540 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17541 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17542 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17543 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17544 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17545 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017546
17547 Example :
17548 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17549 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17550 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17551 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17552 frontend mail
17553 bind :25
17554 mode tcp
17555 maxconn 100
17556 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17557 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17558 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17559 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017560
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017561hostname : string
17562 Returns the system hostname.
17563
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017564int(<integer>) : signed integer
17565 Returns a signed integer.
17566
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017567ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17568 Returns an ipv4.
17569
17570ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17571 Returns an ipv6.
17572
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017573lat_ns_avg : integer
17574 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17575 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17576 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17577 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17578 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17579 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17580 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17581 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17582 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017583 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17584 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17585 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17586 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17587 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17588 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017589
17590lat_ns_tot : integer
17591 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17592 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17593 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17594 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17595 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17596 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17597 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17598 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17599 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017600 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17601 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17602 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17603 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17604 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017605 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17606 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17607 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17608 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17609 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17610 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17611
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017612meth(<method>) : method
17613 Returns a method.
17614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017615nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17616 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17617 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17618 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017619 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17620 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17621 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017622
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017623prio_class : integer
17624 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17625 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17626 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17627
17628prio_offset : integer
17629 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17630 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17631 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17632 set-priority-offset".
17633
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017634proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020017635 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
17636 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017638queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017639 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17640 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17641 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017642 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17643 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17644 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17645 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17646 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17647
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017648rand([<range>]) : integer
17649 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17650 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17651 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17652 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17653 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017655srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17656 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17657 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17658 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17659 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17660 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017661 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17662 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17663
17664srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17665 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17666 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17667 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17668 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17669 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17670 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17671 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17672
17673 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17674 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017675
17676srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17677 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17678 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17679 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017680 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017681 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17682 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17683 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17684
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017685srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17686 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17687 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17688 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17689 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17690 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17691 fetch methods.
17692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017693srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17694 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17695 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017696 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017697 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17698 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017699 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017700 overloading servers).
17701
17702 Example :
17703 # Redirect to a separate back
17704 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17705 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17706 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17707
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017708srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017709 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17710 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17711 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17712
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017713srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017714 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17715 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17716 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17717
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017718srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017719 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17720 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17721 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17722
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017723stopping : boolean
17724 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17725 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17726 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17727
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017728str(<string>) : string
17729 Returns a string.
17730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017731table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17732 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17733 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17734
17735table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17736 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17737 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17738 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17739
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017740thread : integer
17741 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17742 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17743 and debugging purposes.
17744
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017745uuid([<version>]) : string
17746 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17747 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17748 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17749
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017750var(<var-name>) : undefined
17751 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017752 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17753 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017754 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017755 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17756 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017757 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017758 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17759 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017760 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017761 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017762
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200177637.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017764----------------------------------
17765
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017766The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017767closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17768methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17769sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17770TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017771the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17772counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017773"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17774used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17775can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17776Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17777table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17778tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17779currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017780
Remi Tricot-Le Breton942c1672021-09-01 15:52:15 +020017781bc_conn_err : integer
17782 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current backend
17783 connection. See the "fc_conn_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes
17784 and their corresponding error message.
17785
17786bc_conn_err_str : string
17787 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
17788 backend connection, resulting in a connection failure. See the
17789 "fc_conn_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes and their
17790 corresponding error message.
17791
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017792bc_dst : ip
17793 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17794 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17795 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17796 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17797
17798bc_dst_port : integer
17799 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017800 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017801
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017802bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017803 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17804 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17805 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17806
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017807bc_src : ip
17808 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017809 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017810 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17811 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17812
17813bc_src_port : integer
17814 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017815 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017817be_id : integer
17818 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017819 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17820 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017821
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017822be_name : string
17823 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017824 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17825 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017826
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017827be_server_timeout : integer
17828 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17829 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17830 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17831
17832be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17833 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17834 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17835 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17836
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017837cur_server_timeout : integer
17838 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17839 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17840 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17841
17842cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17843 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17844 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17845 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017847dst : ip
17848 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17849 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17850 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17851 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017852 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17853 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17854 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17855 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17856 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17857 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017858
17859dst_conn : integer
17860 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17861 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17862 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17863 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17864 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17865 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17866 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17867 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017868
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017869dst_is_local : boolean
17870 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17871 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17872 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17873 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017874 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017875 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17876 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17877 it only once per connection.
17878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017879dst_port : integer
17880 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17881 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17882 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17883 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17884 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17885 an HTTP header.
17886
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020017887fc_conn_err : integer
17888 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
17889 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
17890 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050017891 described in section 8.2.5). See the "fc_conn_err_str" fetch for a full list of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020017892 error codes and their corresponding error message.
17893
17894fc_conn_err_str : string
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050017895 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020017896 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
17897 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.5). See below for a
17898 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
17899
17900 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
17901 | ID | message |
17902 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
17903 | 0 | "Success" |
17904 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
17905 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
17906 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
17907 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
17908 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
17909 | 6 | "General socket error" |
17910 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
17911 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
17912 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
17913 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
17914 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
17915 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
17916 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
17917 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
17918 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
17919 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
17920 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
17921 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
17922 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
17923 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
17924 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
17925 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
17926 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
17927 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
17928 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
17929 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
17930 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
17931 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
17932 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
17933 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
17934 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
17935 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
17936 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
17937 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
17938 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
17939 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
17940 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
17941 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
17942 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
17943 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
17944 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
17945 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
17946 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
17947
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017948fc_http_major : integer
17949 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17950 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17951 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17952
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017953fc_pp_authority : string
17954 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17955 if any.
17956
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017957fc_pp_unique_id : string
17958 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17959 if any.
17960
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017961fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17962 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17963 header.
17964
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017965fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17966 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17967 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17968 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17969 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17970 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17971 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17972
17973fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17974 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17975 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17976 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17977 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17978 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17979 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17980
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017981fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017982 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17983 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17984 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17985 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17986
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017987fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017988 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17989 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17990 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17991 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17992
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017993fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017994 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17995 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17996 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17997 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17998
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017999fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018000 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
18001 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18002 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18003 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18004
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020018005fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018006 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
18007 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18008 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18009 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18010
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020018011fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018012 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
18013 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18014 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18015 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18016
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020018017fe_defbe : string
18018 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
18019 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
18020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018021fe_id : integer
18022 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010018023 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018024 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
18025
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018026fe_name : string
18027 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
18028 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
18029 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
18030
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010018031fe_client_timeout : integer
18032 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
18033 current frontend.
18034
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018035sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018036sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18037sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18038sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018039 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
18040 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18041 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
18042
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018043sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018044sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18045sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18046sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018047 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
18048 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18049 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
18050
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018051sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18052 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18053 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18054 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18055 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18056 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18057 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18058 will always return zero.
18059 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18060 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18061
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018062sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018063sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18064sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18065sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018066 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18067 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018068 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18069 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18070 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018071
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018072 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018073 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18074 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018075 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18076 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
18077 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018078 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18079 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18080
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018081sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18082sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18083sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18084sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18085 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18086 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
18087 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18088 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18089 when a first ACL was verified.
18090
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018091sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018092sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18093sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18094sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018095 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018096 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
18097
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018098sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018099sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18100sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18101sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018102 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18103 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
18104 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
18105
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018106sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018107sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18108sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18109sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018110 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
18111 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
18112 See also src_conn_rate.
18113
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018114sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18115 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
18116 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
18117 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
18118 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18119 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
18120 index, zero is returned.
18121 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18122 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
18123
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018124sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018125sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18126sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18127sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018128 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018129 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018130
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018131sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18132sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18133sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18134sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18135 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18136 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18137
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018138sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18139 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18140 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
18141 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18142 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18143 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
18144 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
18145 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
18146
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018147sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18148sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18149sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18150sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18151 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18152 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
18153
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018154sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18155 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18156 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
18157 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
18158 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
18159 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
18160 between 0 and 2.
18161 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
18162 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18163 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18164 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18165 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18166
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018167sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018168sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18169sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18170sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018171 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
18172 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18173 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018174 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18175 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18176 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018177
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018178sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18179sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18180sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18181sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18182 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18183 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18184 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18185 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18186 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18187 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18188
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018189sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018190sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18191sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18192sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018193 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018194 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
18195 See also src_http_err_cnt.
18196
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018197sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018198sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18199sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18200sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018201 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
18202 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18203 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
18204 src_http_err_rate.
18205
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018206sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18207sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18208sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18209sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18210 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18211 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18212 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18213
18214sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18215sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18216sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18217sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18218 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18219 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18220 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18221 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18222
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018223sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018224sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18225sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18226sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018227 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018228 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18229 src_http_req_cnt.
18230
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018231sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018232sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18233sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18234sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018235 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18236 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18237 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18238 src_http_req_rate.
18239
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018240sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18241 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18242 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18243 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18244 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18245 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18246 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18247 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
18248 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18249 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18250
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018251sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018252sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18253sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18254sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018255 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018256 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18257 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18258 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18259 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018260
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018261 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018262 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18263 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018264 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18265
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018266sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18267sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18268sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18269sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18270 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18271 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18272 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18273 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18274 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18275
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018276sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018277sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18278sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18279sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018280 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18281 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18282 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018283
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018284sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018285sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18286sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18287sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018288 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18289 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18290 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018291
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018292sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018293sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18294sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18295sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018296 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018297 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18298 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18299 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018300 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018301 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18302
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018303sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018304sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18305sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18306sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018307 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18308 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18309 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18310 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18311 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018312 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018313
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018314sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018315sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18316sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18317sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018318 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18319 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18320 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18321
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018322sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018323sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18324sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18325sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018326 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18327 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018328 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018329 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18330 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018331 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18332 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18333 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018335so_id : integer
18336 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18337 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18338 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018339
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018340so_name : string
18341 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18342 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18343 strings instead of integers.
18344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018345src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018346 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018347 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
18348 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
18349 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018350 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
18351 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
18352 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018353 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
18354 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18355 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18356 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18357 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18358 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18359 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018360
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018361 Example:
18362 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18363 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018365src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18366 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18367 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18368 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018369 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018371src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18372 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18373 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018374 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018375 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018376
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018377src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18378 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18379 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18380 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
18381 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18382 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
18383 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18384 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18385 See also sc_clr_gpc.
18386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018387src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18388 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18389 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18390 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18391 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18392 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18393 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018394
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018395 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018396 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18397 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18398 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18399 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018400 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018401 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18402 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18403
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018404src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18405 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18406 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18407 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18408 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18409 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18410 was verified.
18411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018412src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018413 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018414 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018415 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018416 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018418src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018419 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018420 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18421 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018422 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018424src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18425 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18426 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18427 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018428 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018429
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018430src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18431 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
18432 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
18433 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18434 is an integer between 0 and 99.
18435 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
18436 is returned.
18437 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
18438 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18439 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
18440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018441src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018442 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018443 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018444 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018445 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018446
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018447src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18448 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18449 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18450 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18451 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18452
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018453src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
18454 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18455 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
18456 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
18457 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18458 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
18459 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
18460
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018461src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18462 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18463 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18464 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18465 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18466
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018467src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
18468 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18469 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
18470 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18471 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
18472 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18473 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
18474 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18475 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18476 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18477 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018479src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018480 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018481 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018482 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18483 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018484 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18485 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18486 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018487
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018488src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18489 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18490 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18491 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18492 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18493 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18494 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18495 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018497src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018498 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018499 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018500 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018501 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018502 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018504src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18505 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18506 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18507 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18508 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018509 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018510
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018511src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18512 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18513 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018514 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018515 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18516 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18517
18518src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18519 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18520 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18521 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18522 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18523 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18524 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018526src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018527 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018528 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18529 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018530 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018532src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18533 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18534 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18535 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018536 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018537 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018538
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018539src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18540 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
18541 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18542 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
18543 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18544 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
18545 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18546 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18547 See also sc_inc_gpc.
18548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018549src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18550 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18551 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18552 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018553 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018554 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18555 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018556
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018557 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018558 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018559 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018560 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018561
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018562src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18563 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18564 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18565 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18566 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18567 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18568 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18569
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018570src_is_local : boolean
18571 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18572 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18573 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18574 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018575 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018576 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18577 once per connection.
18578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018579src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018580 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18581 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18582 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18583 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18584 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018586src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018587 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18588 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18589 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18590 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18591 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018593src_port : integer
18594 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18595 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18596 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18597 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018599src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018600 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018601 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18602 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18603 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018604 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018606src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18607 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18608 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18609 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18610 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018611 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018613src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18614 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18615 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18616 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18617 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18618 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18619 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18620 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18621 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018622
18623 Example :
18624 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18625 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18626 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18627 listen ssh
18628 bind :22
18629 mode tcp
18630 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018631 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018632 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018633 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018635srv_id : integer
18636 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18637 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018638 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018639
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018640srv_name : string
18641 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18642 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018643 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018644
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200186457.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018646----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018647
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018648The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018649closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18650when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18651usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018652future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018653
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001865451d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18655 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18656 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18657 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18658 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18659 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18660
18661 Example :
18662 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18663 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18664 # the request.
18665 frontend http-in
18666 bind *:8081
18667 default_backend servers
18668 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18669 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18670
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018671ssl_bc : boolean
18672 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18673 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018674 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18675 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018676
18677ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18678 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018679 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18680 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018681
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018682ssl_bc_alpn : string
18683 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18684 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018685 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018686 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18687 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18688 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18689 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18690 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018691 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18692 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018693
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018694ssl_bc_cipher : string
18695 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018696 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18697 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018698
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018699ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18700 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18701 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18702 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018703 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018704
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020018705ssl_bc_hsk_err : integer
18706 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18707 returns the ID of the latest error that happened during the handshake on the
18708 backend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. In order to get a text
18709 description of this error code, you can either use the "ssl_bc_hsk_err_str"
18710 sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code
18711 in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL
18712 library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
18713
18714ssl_bc_hsk_err_str : string
18715 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18716 returns a string representation of the latest error that happened during the
18717 handshake on the backend side. See also "ssl_fc_hsk_err".
18718
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018719ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18720 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18721 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018722 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18723 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018724
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018725ssl_bc_npn : string
18726 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18727 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018728 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018729 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18730 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18731 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18732 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018733 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18734 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018735
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018736ssl_bc_protocol : string
18737 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018738 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18739 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018740
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018741ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018742 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018743 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018744 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18745 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018746
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018747ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18748 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18749 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18750 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018751 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018752
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018753ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18754 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18755 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018756 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18757 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018758
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018759ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18760 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18761 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18762 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018763 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018764
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018765ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18766 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018767 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18768 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018770ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18771 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18772 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18773 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18774 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18775 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018777ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18778 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18779 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18780 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18781 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018782
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018783ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018784 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18785 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18786 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018787 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018788 does not support resumed sessions.
18789
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018790ssl_c_der : binary
18791 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18792 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18793 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018795ssl_c_err : integer
18796 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18797 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18798 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18799 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18800 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018801
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018802ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018803 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18804 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18805 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18806 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18807 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18808 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18809 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18810 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018811 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18812 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18813 LDAP v3.
18814 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18815 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018817ssl_c_key_alg : string
18818 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18819 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18820 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018822ssl_c_notafter : string
18823 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18824 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18825 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018827ssl_c_notbefore : string
18828 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18829 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18830 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018831
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018832ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018833 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18834 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18835 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18836 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18837 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18838 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18839 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18840 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018841 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18842 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18843 LDAP v3.
18844 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18845 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018847ssl_c_serial : binary
18848 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18849 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18850 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018852ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18853 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18854 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18855 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018856 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18857 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18858
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018859 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018860 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018862ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18863 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18864 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18865 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018867ssl_c_used : boolean
18868 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18869 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018871ssl_c_verify : integer
18872 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18873 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18874 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18875 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018877ssl_c_version : integer
18878 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18879 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018880
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018881ssl_f_der : binary
18882 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18883 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18884 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18885
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018886ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018887 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18888 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18889 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18890 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018891 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018892 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18893 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18894 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018895 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18896 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18897 LDAP v3.
18898 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18899 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018901ssl_f_key_alg : string
18902 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18903 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18904 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018906ssl_f_notafter : string
18907 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18908 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18909 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018911ssl_f_notbefore : string
18912 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18913 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18914 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018915
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018916ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018917 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18918 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18919 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18920 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18921 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18922 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18923 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18924 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018925 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18926 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18927 LDAP v3.
18928 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18929 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018931ssl_f_serial : binary
18932 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18933 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18934 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018935
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018936ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18937 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18938 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18939 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018941ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18942 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18943 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18944 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018946ssl_f_version : integer
18947 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18948 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18949
18950ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018951 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18952 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18953 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018955 Example :
18956 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18957 listen http-https
18958 bind :80
18959 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18960 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18961
18962ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18963 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18964 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18965
18966ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018967 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018968 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018969 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018970 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18971 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18972 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18973 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18974 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18975 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018977ssl_fc_cipher : string
18978 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18979 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018980
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018981ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
18982 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18983 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020018984 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018985 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
18986 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
18987 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018988
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018989 Example:
18990 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
18991 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18992 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18993 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18994 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
18995 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
18996 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
18997 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
18998 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
18999
19000ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019001 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019002 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019003 capture buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
19004 Setting <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019005 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19006 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019007
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019008ssl_fc_cipherlist_str([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019009 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019010 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019011 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019012 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19013 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19014 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19015 Note that this sample-fetch is only available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the
19016 function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash like
19017 "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019018
19019ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019020 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can return only if the value
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019021 "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash take
19022 into account all the data of the cipher list.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019023
19024ssl_fc_ecformats_bin : binary
19025 Return the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curve point
19026 formats. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019027 buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019028
19029 Example:
19030 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19031 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19032 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19033 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19034 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19035 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19036 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19037 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19038 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19039
19040ssl_fc_eclist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19041 Returns the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curves. The
19042 maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019043 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019044 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19045 0 : return the full list of supported elliptic curves (default)
19046 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19047
19048 Example:
19049 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19050 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19051 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19052 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19053 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19054 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19055 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19056 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19057 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19058
19059ssl_fc_extlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19060 Returns the binary form of the client hello extension list. The maximum
19061 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019062 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019063 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19064 0 : return the full list of extensions (default)
19065 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19066
19067 Example:
19068 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19069 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19070 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19071 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19072 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19073 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19074 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19075 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19076 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019077
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019078ssl_fc_client_random : binary
19079 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19080 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19081 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19082
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019083ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
19084 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19085 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19086 transport layer.
19087 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19088 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19089 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19090 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19091
19092ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19093 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19094 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19095 transport layer.
19096 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19097 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19098 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19099 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19100
19101ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
19102 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19103 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19104 transport layer.
19105 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19106 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19107 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19108 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19109
19110ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
19111 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19112 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19113 transport layer.
19114 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19115 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19116 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19117 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19118
19119ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
19120 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19121 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19122 transport layer.
19123 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19124 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19125 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19126 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019128ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019129 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
19130 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010019131 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
19132 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
19133 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
19134 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019135
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020019136ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
19137 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
19138 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
19139 wait until the handshake happened.
19140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019141ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
19142 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019143 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
19144 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019145 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019146 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019147
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c6898e2021-07-29 09:45:51 +020019148ssl_fc_hsk_err : integer
19149 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19150 returns the ID of the latest error that happened during the handshake on the
19151 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. Any error happening during
19152 the client's certificate verification process will not be raised through this
19153 fetch but via the existing "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and
19154 "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get a text description of this
19155 error code, you can either use the "ssl_fc_hsk_err_str" sample fetch or use
19156 the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code in hexadecimal
19157 representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL library's
19158 documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
19159
19160ssl_fc_hsk_err_str : string
19161 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19162 returns a string representation of the latest error that happened during the
19163 handshake on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
19164 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
19165 also "ssl_fc_hsk_err".
19166
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020019167ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019168 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010019169 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
19170 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019172ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019173 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019174 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019175 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
19176 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
19177 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
19178 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
19179 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
19180 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020019181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019182ssl_fc_protocol : string
19183 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
19184 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019185
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019186ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id : integer
19187 The version of the TLS protocol by which the client wishes to communicate
19188 during the session as indicated in client hello message. This value can
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019189 return only if the value "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than
19190 0.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019191
19192 Example:
19193 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19194 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19195 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19196 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19197 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19198 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19199 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19200 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19201 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19202
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019203ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019204 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019205 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
19206 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019207
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019208ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19209 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19210 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19211 transport layer.
19212 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19213 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19214 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19215 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19216
19217ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
19218 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19219 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19220 transport layer.
19221 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19222 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19223 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19224 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19225
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019226ssl_fc_server_random : binary
19227 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19228 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19229 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019231ssl_fc_session_id : binary
19232 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
19233 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
19234 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
19235 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019236
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019237ssl_fc_session_key : binary
19238 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
19239 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
19240 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
19241 BoringSSL.
19242
19243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019244ssl_fc_sni : string
19245 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
19246 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019247 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019248 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
19249 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
19250
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019251 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019252 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019253 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019254 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020019255 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019257 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019258 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
19259 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020019260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019261ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
19262 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
19263 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019264
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019265ssl_s_der : binary
19266 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
19267 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19268 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19269
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019270ssl_s_chain_der : binary
19271 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
19272 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19273 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019274 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019275 does not support resumed sessions.
19276
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019277ssl_s_key_alg : string
19278 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19279 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
19280 SSL/TLS transport layer.
19281
19282ssl_s_notafter : string
19283 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
19284 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19285 transport layer.
19286
19287ssl_s_notbefore : string
19288 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
19289 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19290 transport layer.
19291
19292ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19293 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19294 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19295 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19296 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19297 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19298 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019299 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19300 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019301 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19302 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19303 LDAP v3.
19304 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19305 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19306
19307ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19308 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19309 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19310 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19311 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19312 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19313 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019314 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19315 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019316 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19317 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19318 LDAP v3.
19319 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19320 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19321
19322ssl_s_serial : binary
19323 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
19324 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19325 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19326
19327ssl_s_sha1 : binary
19328 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
19329 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19330 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19331
19332ssl_s_sig_alg : string
19333 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19334 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19335 layer.
19336
19337ssl_s_version : integer
19338 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
19339 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019340
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200193417.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019342------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019344Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
19345sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
19346only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
19347For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
19348be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
19349can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
19350sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
19351for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
19352content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019353
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019354Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
19355 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019356 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019357 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
19358 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
19359 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
19360 sample expression). So be careful.
19361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019362payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019363 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019364 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
19365 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019367payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
19368 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019369 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019370 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019372req.len : integer
19373req_len : integer (deprecated)
19374 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19375 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19376 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19377 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19378 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019379 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019380 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
19381 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019383req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19384 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019385 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
19386 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
19387 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
19388 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019390 ACL alternatives :
19391 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019393req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19394 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19395 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19396 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19397 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019399 ACL alternatives :
19400 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019402 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019404req.proto_http : boolean
19405req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19406 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19407 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19408 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19409 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19410 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19411 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19412 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019414 Example:
19415 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19416 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19417 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019418 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019420req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19421rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19422 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19423 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19424 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19425 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19426 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19427 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19428 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019430 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19431 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19432 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19433 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19434 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19435 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019437 ACL derivatives :
19438 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019440 Example :
19441 listen tse-farm
19442 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19443 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19444 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19445 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19446 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19447 persist rdp-cookie
19448 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19449 # This is only useful makes sense if
19450 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19451 stick-table type string size 204800
19452 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19453 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19454 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019456 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
19457 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019459req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19460rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19461 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19462 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19463 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19464 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019466 ACL derivatives :
19467 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019468
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019469req.ssl_alpn : string
19470 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19471 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19472 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19473 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19474 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19475 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019476 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019477
19478 Examples :
19479 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19480 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19481 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019482 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019483 default_backend bk_default
19484
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019485req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19486 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19487 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019488 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19489 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19490 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19491 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19492 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019494req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19495req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19496 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19497 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19498 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19499 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19500 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19501 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19502 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019504req.ssl_sni : string
19505req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19506 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19507 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19508 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19509 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19510 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019511 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19512 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19513 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19514 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19515 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19516 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19517 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19518 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19519 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019521 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019522 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019524 Examples :
19525 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19526 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19527 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019528 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019529 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019530
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019531req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19532 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19533 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19534 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19535 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19536 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19537 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19538 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19539 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19540 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019542req.ssl_ver : integer
19543req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19544 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19545 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19546 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19547 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19548 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19549 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19550 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019551 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019552 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019554 ACL derivatives :
19555 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019556
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019557res.len : integer
19558 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19559 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19560 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19561 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19562 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019563 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019564 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019565 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019567res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19568 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019569 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019570 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019571 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019572 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019574res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19575 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19576 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19577 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019578 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19579 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019581 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019582
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019583res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19584rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19585 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19586 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19587 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19588 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19589 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19590 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19591 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019593wait_end : boolean
19594 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19595 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019596 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019597 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19598 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019599 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019600 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19601 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019603 Examples :
19604 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19605 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19606 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019608 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19609 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19610 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19611 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19612 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19613 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19614 tcp-request content reject
19615
19616
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200196177.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019618--------------------------------------
19619
19620It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19621This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19622data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19623its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19624HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19625content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19626to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19627more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19628response are indexed.
19629
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019630Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19631 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19632 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19633 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19634 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19635 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19636 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019638base : string
19639 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19640 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19641 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19642 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19643 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19644 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19645 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19646 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19647
19648 ACL derivatives :
19649 base : exact string match
19650 base_beg : prefix match
19651 base_dir : subdir match
19652 base_dom : domain match
19653 base_end : suffix match
19654 base_len : length match
19655 base_reg : regex match
19656 base_sub : substring match
19657
19658base32 : integer
19659 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19660 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19661 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019662 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19663 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19664 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019665
19666base32+src : binary
19667 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19668 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19669 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19670 per-URL counters.
19671
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019672baseq : string
19673 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19674 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19675 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19676 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19677
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019678capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19679 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19680 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19681 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19682
19683capture.req.method : string
19684 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19685 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19686 because it's allocated.
19687
19688capture.req.uri : string
19689 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19690 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19691 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19692 allocated.
19693
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019694capture.req.ver : string
19695 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19696 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19697 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19698
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019699capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19700 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19701 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19702 The first entry is an index of 0.
19703 See also: "capture response header"
19704
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019705capture.res.ver : string
19706 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19707 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19708 persistent flag.
19709
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019710req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019711 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19712 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19713 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019714
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019715req.body_param([<name>) : string
19716 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19717 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19718 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19719 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19720 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19721 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19722 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19723 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19724 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19725 given.
19726
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019727req.body_len : integer
19728 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19729 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019730 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19731 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019732
19733req.body_size : integer
19734 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019735 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19736 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019738req.cook([<name>]) : string
19739cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19740 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19741 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19742 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19743 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19744 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19745 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19746 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19747 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19748
19749 ACL derivatives :
19750 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19751 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19752 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19753 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19754 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19755 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19756 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19757 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019759req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19760cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19761 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19762 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019764req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19765cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19766 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19767 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19768 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19769 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019771cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19772 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19773 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19774 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19775 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019776 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019777 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19778 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19779 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19780 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019782hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19783 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19784 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19785 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19786 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019787 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019789req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019790 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19791 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19792 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19793 with headers such as User-Agent.
19794
19795 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19796 found.
19797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019798 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19799 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19800 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019801 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019803req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19804 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19805 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019806 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19807 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019809req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019810 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19811 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19812 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19813 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19814 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19815 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19816 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19817
19818 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19819 found.
19820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019821 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19822 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19823 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019824 with -1 being the last one.
19825
19826 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19827 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019829 ACL derivatives :
19830 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19831 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19832 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19833 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19834 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19835 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19836 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19837 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19838
19839req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19840hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19841 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19842 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019843 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19844 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19845 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19846
19847 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19848 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19849 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19850
19851 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019852
19853req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19854hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19855 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19856 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19857 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019858 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19859 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19860 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19861 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19862 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019863
19864 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19865
19866 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019867
19868req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19869hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19870 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19871 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19872 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019873
19874 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19875
19876 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019877
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019878req.hdrs : string
19879 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19880 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19881 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19882 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19883
19884req.hdrs_bin : binary
19885 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19886 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19887 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19888 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19889 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19890 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19891
19892 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019893
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019894 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19895 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019897http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19898 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19899 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19900 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19901 basic auth is supported.
19902
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019903http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19904 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19905 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19906 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19907 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019908 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19909 basic auth is supported.
19910
19911 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019912 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19913 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19914 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19915 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019916
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019917http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019918 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19919 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19920 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019921
19922http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019923 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19924 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19925 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019926
19927http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019928 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19929 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19930 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019932http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019933 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19934 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019935 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19936 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019938method : integer + string
19939 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19940 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19941 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19942 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19943 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19944 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19945 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019947 ACL derivatives :
19948 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019950 Example :
19951 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19952 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19953 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019955path : string
19956 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19957 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19958 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19959 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19960 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019961 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019962 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019964 ACL derivatives :
19965 path : exact string match
19966 path_beg : prefix match
19967 path_dir : subdir match
19968 path_dom : domain match
19969 path_end : suffix match
19970 path_len : length match
19971 path_reg : regex match
19972 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019973
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019974pathq : string
19975 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19976 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19977 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19978 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19979 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19980 result in both cases.
19981
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019982query : string
19983 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19984 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19985 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19986 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019987 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019988 which stops before the question mark.
19989
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019990req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19991 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19992 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19993 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19994 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019996req.ver : string
19997req_ver : string (deprecated)
19998 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19999 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
20000 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020002 ACL derivatives :
20003 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020004
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020005res.body : binary
20006 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
20007 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020008 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20009
20010 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020011
20012res.body_len : integer
20013 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
20014 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020015 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20016
20017 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020018
20019res.body_size : integer
20020 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
20021 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
20022 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
20023 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020024 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20025
20026 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020027
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010020028res.cache_hit : boolean
20029 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
20030 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
20031
20032res.cache_name : string
20033 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
20034 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
20035 empty string.
20036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020037res.comp : boolean
20038 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
20039 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
20040 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020042res.comp_algo : string
20043 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
20044 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
20045 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020047res.cook([<name>]) : string
20048scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20049 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20050 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020051 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
20052
20053 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020020054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020055 ACL derivatives :
20056 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020020057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020058res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20059scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20060 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
20061 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020062 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
20063
20064 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020066res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
20067scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20068 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20069 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020070 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
20071
20072 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020074res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020075 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20076 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20077
20078 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
20079 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
20080
20081 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
20082
20083 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020085res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020086 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20087 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20088
20089 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
20090 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
20091
20092 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020094res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
20095shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020096 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20097 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20098
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020099 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020100 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
20101
20102 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020104 ACL derivatives :
20105 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
20106 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
20107 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
20108 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
20109 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
20110 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
20111 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
20112 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
20113
20114res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20115shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020116 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20117 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20118
20119 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020120 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020121
20122 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020124res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
20125shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020126 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
20127 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20128
20129 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20130
20131 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020132
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020133res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
20134 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
20135 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
20136 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020137 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
20138
20139 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020141res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
20142shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020143 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
20144 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20145
20146 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20147
20148 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020149
20150res.hdrs : string
20151 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
20152 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
20153 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020154 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
20155
20156 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020157
20158res.hdrs_bin : binary
20159 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
20160 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
20161 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
20162 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
20163 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
20164 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
20165 (length of 0 for both).
20166
20167 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
20168
20169 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
20170 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010020171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020172res.ver : string
20173resp_ver : string (deprecated)
20174 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020175 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
20176
20177 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020179 ACL derivatives :
20180 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010020181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020182set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20183 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20184 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020020185 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020186 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020188 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
20189 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020191status : integer
20192 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
20193 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020194 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
20195
20196 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020197
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020020198unique-id : string
20199 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
20200 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
20201 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
20202 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
20203 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
20204 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
20205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020206url : string
20207 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
20208 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
20209 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
20210 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
20211 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
20212 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
20213 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020215 ACL derivatives :
20216 url : exact string match
20217 url_beg : prefix match
20218 url_dir : subdir match
20219 url_dom : domain match
20220 url_end : suffix match
20221 url_len : length match
20222 url_reg : regex match
20223 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020225url_ip : ip
20226 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
20227 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
20228 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
20229 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020230 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
20231 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020233url_port : integer
20234 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020235 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020236
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020237urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
20238url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020239 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
20240 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020241 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
20242 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
20243 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
20244 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020245 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
20246 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020247 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
20248 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020250 ACL derivatives :
20251 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
20252 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
20253 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
20254 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
20255 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
20256 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
20257 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
20258 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020259
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020261 Example :
20262 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
20263 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
20264 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
20265 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020266
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020267urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020268 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
20269 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
20270 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020020271
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020020272url32 : integer
20273 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
20274 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
20275 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
20276 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
20277 is an unsigned integer.
20278
20279url32+src : binary
20280 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
20281 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
20282 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
20283
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020020284
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200202857.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020286---------------------------------------
20287
20288This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
20289used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
20290purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
20291There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
20292or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
20293any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
20294for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
20295
20296internal.htx.data : integer
20297 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
20298 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20299
20300internal.htx.free : integer
20301 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
20302 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20303
20304internal.htx.free_data : integer
20305 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
20306 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20307
20308internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010020309 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
20310 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
20311 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020312
20313internal.htx.nbblks : integer
20314 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
20315 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20316
20317internal.htx.size : integer
20318 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
20319 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20320
20321internal.htx.used : integer
20322 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
20323 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20324 direction.
20325
20326internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
20327 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20328 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
20329 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
20330 of the special value :
20331 * head : The oldest inserted block
20332 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020333 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020334
20335internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
20336 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20337 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
20338 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
20339 integer or one of the special value :
20340 * head : The oldest inserted block
20341 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020342 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020343
20344internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
20345 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20346 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
20347 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20348 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20349
20350 * head : The oldest inserted block
20351 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020352 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020353
20354internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
20355 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20356 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20357 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20358 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20359
20360 * head : The oldest inserted block
20361 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020362 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020363
20364internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
20365 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20366 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20367 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20368 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20369
20370 * head : The oldest inserted block
20371 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020372 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020373
20374internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
20375 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
20376 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
20377 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20378 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20379
20380 * head : The oldest inserted block
20381 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020382 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020383
20384internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
20385 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
20386 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
20387 it returns false.
20388
20389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200203907.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020391---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020392
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020393Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
20394every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020020395order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020396
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020397ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020398---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
20399FALSE always_false never match
20400HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20401HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20402HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020403HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020404HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20405HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20406HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20407HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
20408LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
20409METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20410METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20411METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20412METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20413METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20414METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20415METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20416METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20417RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20418REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20419TRUE always_true always match
20420WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20421---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020422
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020423
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204248. Logging
20425----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020426
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020427One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20428provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20429very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20430provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20431state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020432to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020433headers.
20434
20435In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20436about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20437send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20438
20439 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20440 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20441 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20442 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20443 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020444 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020445 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020446
20447The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20448allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20449as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20450while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20451real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20452delay.
20453
20454
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204558.1. Log levels
20456---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020457
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020458TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020459source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020460HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20461in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20462track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20463syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20464about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020465
20466
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204678.2. Log formats
20468----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020469
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020470HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020471and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20472slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20473options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020474
20475 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20476 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20477 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20478 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20479 extents.
20480
20481 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20482 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20483 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20484 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20485 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20486
20487 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20488 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20489 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20490 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20491 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20492
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020493 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20494 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20495 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20496 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20497
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020498 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20499
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020500Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20501specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20502field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20503servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20504always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20505identifier.
20506
20507Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20508 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20509 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20510 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20511 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20512
20513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205148.2.1. Default log format
20515-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020516
20517This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20518as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20519format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20520
20521 Example :
20522 listen www
20523 mode http
20524 log global
20525 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20526
20527 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20528 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20529 (www/HTTP)
20530
20531 Field Format Extract from the example above
20532 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20533 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20534 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20535 4 'to' to
20536 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20537 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20538
20539Detailed fields description :
20540 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20541 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20542 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20543 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20544 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20545 and processed the connection.
20546 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20547
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020548In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20549"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20550connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20551
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020552It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20553will eventually disappear.
20554
20555
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205568.2.2. TCP log format
20557---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020558
20559The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20560is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20561information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20562counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20563emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20564environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20565the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20566sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020567specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20568not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20569fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20570marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020571
20572 Example :
20573 frontend fnt
20574 mode tcp
20575 option tcplog
20576 log global
20577 default_backend bck
20578
20579 backend bck
20580 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20581
20582 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20583 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20584 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20585
20586 Field Format Extract from the example above
20587 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20588 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20589 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20590 4 frontend_name fnt
20591 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20592 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20593 7 bytes_read* 212
20594 8 termination_state --
20595 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20596 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20597
20598Detailed fields description :
20599 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020600 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020601 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20602 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020603 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020604 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020605 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020606
20607 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020608 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20609 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20610 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020611
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020612 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020613 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20614 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020615 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20616 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20617 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20618 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020619
20620 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20621 and processed the connection.
20622
20623 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20624 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20625 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20626 applications.
20627
20628 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20629 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20630 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20631 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20632 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20633
20634 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20635 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20636 See "Timers" below for more details.
20637
20638 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20639 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20640 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20641 "Timers" below for more details.
20642
20643 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020644 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020645 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20646 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20647 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20648 details.
20649
20650 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20651 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20652 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20653 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20654 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20655
20656 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20657 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20658 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20659 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20660 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20661 for more details.
20662
20663 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020664 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020665 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20666 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20667 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020668 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020669
20670 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20671 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20672 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20673 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20674 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20675 caused by a denial of service attack.
20676
20677 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20678 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20679 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20680 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20681 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20682 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20683 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20684 denial of service attack.
20685
20686 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20687 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20688 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20689 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20690 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20691 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20692 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20693 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20694 be processed than on other servers.
20695
20696 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20697 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20698 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20699 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020700 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020701 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20702 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20703 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20704 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20705 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20706 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20707 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20708 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20709
20710 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20711 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20712 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20713 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20714 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20715 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020716 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020717 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20718
20719 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20720 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20721 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20722 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20723 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20724 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020725 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020726 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20727 occurs.
20728
20729
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207308.2.3. HTTP log format
20731----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020732
20733The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20734is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20735the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20736are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20737emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20738generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20739"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20740which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020741frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20742is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020743
20744Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20745slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20746with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20747
20748 Example :
20749 frontend http-in
20750 mode http
20751 option httplog
20752 log global
20753 default_backend bck
20754
20755 backend static
20756 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20757
20758 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20759 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20760 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020761 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020762
20763 Field Format Extract from the example above
20764 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20765 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020766 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020767 4 frontend_name http-in
20768 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020769 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020770 7 status_code 200
20771 8 bytes_read* 2750
20772 9 captured_request_cookie -
20773 10 captured_response_cookie -
20774 11 termination_state ----
20775 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20776 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20777 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20778 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20779 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020780
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020781Detailed fields description :
20782 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020783 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020784 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20785 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020786 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020787 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020788 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020789
20790 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020791 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20792 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20793 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020794
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020795 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020796 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020797
20798 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20799 and processed the connection.
20800
20801 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20802 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20803 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20804
20805 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20806 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20807 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20808 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20809 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20810 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20811
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020812 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20813 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20814 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020815 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020816 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20817 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020818 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020819 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020820
20821 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20822 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020823 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020824
20825 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20826 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020827 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20828 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020829
20830 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20831 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20832 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20833 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20834 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020835 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20836 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020837
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020838 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020839 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20840 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20841 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20842 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20843 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20844 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020845 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020846
20847 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020848 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
20849 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020850
20851 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20852 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020853 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020854 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20855 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20856 overflowing.
20857
20858 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20859 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20860 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20861 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20862 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20863 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20864 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20865 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20866
20867 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20868 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20869 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20870 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20871 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20872 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20873 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20874 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20875
20876 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20877 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20878 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20879 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20880 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20881 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20882 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20883
20884 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020885 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020886 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20887 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20888 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020889 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020890 system.
20891
20892 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20893 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20894 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20895 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20896 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20897 caused by a denial of service attack.
20898
20899 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20900 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20901 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20902 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20903 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20904 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20905 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20906 denial of service attack.
20907
20908 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20909 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20910 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20911 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20912 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20913 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20914 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20915 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20916 processed than on other servers.
20917
20918 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20919 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20920 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20921 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020922 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020923 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20924 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20925 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20926 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20927 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20928 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20929 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20930 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20931
20932 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20933 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20934 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20935 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20936 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20937 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020938 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020939 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20940
20941 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20942 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20943 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20944 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20945 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20946 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020947 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020948 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20949 occurs.
20950
20951 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20952 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20953 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20954 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20955 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20956 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20957 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20958 cookies" below for more details.
20959
20960 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20961 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20962 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20963 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20964 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20965 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20966 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20967 and cookies" below for more details.
20968
20969 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20970 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20971 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20972 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20973 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20974 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20975 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20976 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20977
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020020978
209798.2.4. HTTPS log format
20980----------------------
20981
20982The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
20983extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
20984information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
20985frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
20986end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
20987matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
20988sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
20989dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
20990"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
20991
20992This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
20993appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
20994HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020995
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020020996 Example :
20997 frontend https-in
20998 mode http
20999 option httpslog
21000 log global
21001 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
21002 default_backend bck
21003
21004 backend static
21005 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
21006
21007 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
21008 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
21009 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
21010 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0 TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
21011
21012 Field Format Extract from the example above
21013 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
21014 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
21015 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
21016 4 frontend_name https-in
21017 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
21018 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
21019 7 status_code 200
21020 8 bytes_read* 2750
21021 9 captured_request_cookie -
21022 10 captured_response_cookie -
21023 11 termination_state ----
21024 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
21025 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
21026 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
21027 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
21028 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
William Lallemandfdc3faf2021-08-02 10:57:49 +020021029 17 fc_conn_err '/' ssl_fc_hsk_err '/' ssl_c_err '/' ssl_c_ca_err 0/0/0/0
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021030 18 ssl_version '/' ssl_ciphers TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
21031
21032Detailed fields description :
William Lallemandfdc3faf2021-08-02 10:57:49 +020021033 - "fc_conn_err" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021034 corresponds to the "fc_conn_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_conn_err" and
21035 "fc_conn_err_str" fetches for more information.
21036
21037 - "ssl_fc_hsk_err" is the status of the SSL handshake from the frontend's
21038 point of view. It will be 0 if everything went well. See the
21039 "ssl_fc_hsk_err" sample fetch's description for more information.
21040
21041 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
21042 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
21043 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
21044 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
21045
21046 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
21047 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
21048 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
21049 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
21050
21051 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
21052
21053 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
21054
21055
210568.2.5. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021057------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021058
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021059The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021060mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021061
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021062HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021063Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
21064separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
21065prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
21066
21067Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
21068variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021069("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021070
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010021071If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020021072as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010021073less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
21074the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
21075
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020021076Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
21077"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
21078delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
21079preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021080
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021081Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
21082'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
21083https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
21084such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
21085
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021086Flags are :
21087 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021088 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021089 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
21090 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021091
21092 Example:
21093
21094 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
21095 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
21096
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021097 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
21098
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021099At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
21100
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021101 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21102 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021103
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021104the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021105
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021106 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
21107 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
21108 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021109
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021110the default HTTPS format is defined this way :
21111
21112 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21113 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
21114 %[fc_conn_err]/%[ssl_fc_hsk_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/%[ssl_c_ca_err] \
21115 %sslv/%sslc"
21116
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021117and the default TCP format is defined this way :
21118
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021119 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
21120 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021121
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021122Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
21123
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021124 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021125 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021126 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
21127 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
21128 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021129 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
21130 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
21131 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021132 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000021133 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000021134 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000021135 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000021136 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000021137 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
21138 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010021139 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020021140 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021141 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021142 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021143 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020021144 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080021145 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021146 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
21147 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
21148 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
21149 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
21150 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021151 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021152 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021153 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021154 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021155 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021156 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
21157 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021158 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
21159 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
21160 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021161 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021162 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
21163 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021164 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021165 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
21166 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
21167 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020021168 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020021169 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021170 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
21171 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
21172 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
21173 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020021174 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021175 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021176 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021177 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010021178 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021179 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021180 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
21181 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
21182 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021183 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021184 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
21185 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021186 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021187 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
21188 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020021189 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021190 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021191 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021192 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021193
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021194 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021195
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021196
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +0200211978.2.6. Error log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021198-----------------------
21199
21200When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +020021201protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format,
21202unless a dedicated error log format is defined through an "error-log-format"
21203line. In the latter case, the legacy log format described below will not be
21204used anymore, and all error log lines will follow the defined format.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021205By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
21206"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021207will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +020021208logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021209
21210The format looks like this :
21211
21212 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
21213 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
21214 Connection error during SSL handshake
21215
21216 Field Format Extract from the example above
21217 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
21218 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
21219 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
21220 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
21221 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
21222
21223These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
21224failures.
21225
21226
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212278.3. Advanced logging options
21228-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021229
21230Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
21231just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
21232options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
21233for more information about their usage.
21234
21235
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212368.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
21237------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021238
21239It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021240HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021241commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
21242monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
21243ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
21244
21245 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
21246 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
21247 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
21248 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
21249
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020021250 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
21251 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021252
21253 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
21254 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
21255 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
21256
21257
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212588.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
21259----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021260
21261The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
21262what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
21263or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021264"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021265just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
21266log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
21267after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
21268is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
21269with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
21270with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
21271
21272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212738.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
21274------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021275
21276Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
21277for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
21278"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
21279retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
21280raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
21281a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
21282file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
21283you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
21284"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
21285
21286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212878.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
21288--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021289
21290Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
21291multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
21292them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
21293"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
21294logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
21295error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
21296and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
21297too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
21298useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
21299alternative.
21300
21301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213028.4. Timing events
21303------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021304
21305Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
21306reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
21307the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
21308frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021309mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
21310addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
21311
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010021312Timings events in HTTP mode:
21313
21314 first request 2nd request
21315 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
21316 t tr t tr ...
21317 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
21318 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
21319 :<---- Tq ---->: :
21320 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021321 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010021322 :<--------- Ta --------->:
21323
21324Timings events in TCP mode:
21325
21326 TCP session
21327 |<----------------->|
21328 t t
21329 ---|----|----|----|----|---
21330 | Th Tw Tc Td |
21331 |<------ Tt ------->|
21332
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021333 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021334 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021335 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
21336 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
21337 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021338 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021339 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
21340 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
21341 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
21342 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021343
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021344 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
21345 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
21346 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021347 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
21348 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
21349 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
21350 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
21351 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
21352 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021353
21354 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
21355 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
21356 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
21357 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
21358 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
21359 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
21360 request typed by hand during a test.
21361
21362 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
21363 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021364 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021365 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
21366 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
21367 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
21368 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021369
21370 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
21371 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
21372 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
21373 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
21374 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
21375
21376 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
21377 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
21378 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
21379 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
21380 connection never established.
21381
21382 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
21383 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
21384 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
21385 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
21386 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
21387 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
21388 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
21389 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
21390 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
21391 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
21392 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
21393
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021394 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
21395 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
21396 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
21397 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
21398 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
21399 by subtracting other timers when valid :
21400
21401 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
21402
21403 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
21404 "Ta" can never be negative.
21405
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021406 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
21407 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021408 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
21409 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021410 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021411
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021412 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021413
21414 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021415 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
21416 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021417
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021418 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
21419 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
21420 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
21421 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
21422 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
21423 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
21424 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
21425 prefixed with a '+' sign.
21426
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021427These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
21428protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
21429that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021430due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
21431"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
21432that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021433
21434Most common cases :
21435
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021436 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
21437 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
21438 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
21439 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
21440 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021441 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021442 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
21443 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
21444 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
21445 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
21446 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020021447 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021448
21449 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
21450 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
21451 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
21452 of ms on remote networks.
21453
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021454 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
21455 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
21456 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021457
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021458 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
21459 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021460 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021461 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
21462 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
21463 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
21464 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
21465 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
21466 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021467
21468Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
21469
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021470 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021471 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021472 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021473
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021474 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021475 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
21476 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
21477
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021478 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021479 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
21480 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
21481 flags.
21482
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021483 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
21484 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021485 Check the session termination flags, then check the
21486 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
21487 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
21488 the client connection was maintained open.
21489
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021490 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021491 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021492 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021493 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
21494
21495
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214968.5. Session state at disconnection
21497-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021498
21499TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
21500"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
215012-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
21502each of which has a special meaning :
21503
21504 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
21505 session to terminate :
21506
21507 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21508
21509 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21510 server explicitly refused it.
21511
21512 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21513 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21514 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
21515 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021516 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021517
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021518 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021519 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021520
21521 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
21522 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
21523 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
21524 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
21525 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
21526
21527 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
21528 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
21529 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
21530 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
21531 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
21532
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021533 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090021534 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
21535
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021536 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070021537 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
21538 backup connections when going up.
21539
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021540 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020021541
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021542 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
21543 send or receive data.
21544
21545 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
21546 send or receive data.
21547
21548 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
21549 with nothing left in the buffers.
21550
21551 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
21552
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010021553 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021554 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
21555
21556 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
21557 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
21558 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
21559 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
21560 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
21561
21562 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
21563 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
21564
21565 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
21566 server (HTTP only).
21567
21568 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
21569
21570 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
21571 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
21572 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
21573
21574 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
21575 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
21576 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
21577
21578 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
21579
21580 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
21581 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
21582
21583 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
21584 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21585 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21586
21587 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21588 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021589 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21590 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021591
21592 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21593 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21594 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21595 another server.
21596
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021597 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021598 server.
21599
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021600 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21601 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21602 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21603 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21604
21605 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21606 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21607 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21608 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21609
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021610 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21611 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21612 "use-server" rule).
21613
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021614 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21615
21616 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21617 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21618
21619 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21620
21621 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21622 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21623 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21624
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021625 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21626 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021627 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021628 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21629 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21630
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021631 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21632
21633 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21634 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21635
21636 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21637
21638 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21639
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021640The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21641was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021642helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21643starvation, attacks, etc...
21644
21645The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21646alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21647easier finding and understanding.
21648
21649 Flags Reason
21650
21651 -- Normal termination.
21652
21653 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021654 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21655 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021656 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21657
21658 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21659 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021660 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21661 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021662 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21663 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021664
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021665 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21666 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021667 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021668
21669 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21670 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21671 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21672
21673 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21674 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21675 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21676 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21677 the server takes too long to respond.
21678
21679 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21680 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21681 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21682 long a time to respond.
21683
21684 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21685 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21686 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021687 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021688 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21689 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021690
21691 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21692 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21693 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21694 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21695 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021696 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021697 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21698 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21699 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21700 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21701 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21702 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21703 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21704 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021705 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021706 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21707 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21708 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021709
21710 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21711 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021712 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21713 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21714 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21715 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021716
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021717 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021718 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21719
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021720 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021721 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21722 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021723 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021724 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21725 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21726
21727 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21728 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21729 503 or 504 here.
21730
21731 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021732 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021733 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21734 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21735 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21736
21737 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21738 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021739 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021740 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021741 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021742
21743 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21744 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21745 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21746 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21747 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21748 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021749 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021750
21751 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21752 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21753 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21754 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21755 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21756 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21757 solution is to fix the application.
21758
21759 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21760 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21761 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21762 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21763 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21764 external attacks.
21765
21766 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021767 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021768 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021769 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21770 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21771
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021772 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21773 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21774 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021775 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021776 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021777
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021778 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21779 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21780 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21781 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021782 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21783 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21784 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21785 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
21786 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021787
21788 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21789 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21790 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
21791 returned an HTTP 403 error.
21792
21793 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21794 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21795 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21796 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21797
21798 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21799 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21800 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21801 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21802
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021803The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021804persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021805important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21806re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21807
21808 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21809
21810 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21811 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21812 set on a GET request.
21813
21814 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21815 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021816 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021817 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21818
21819 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21820 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21821 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21822
21823 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21824 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21825 already got a cookie.
21826
21827 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21828 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21829 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21830 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21831 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21832
21833 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21834 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21835 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21836
21837 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21838 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21839 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21840
21841 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21842 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21843
21844 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21845 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21846 then advertised in the response.
21847
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021848
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218498.6. Non-printable characters
21850-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021851
21852In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21853consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21854converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21855prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21856being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21857escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21858is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21859'}' when logging headers.
21860
21861Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21862issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21863containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21864
21865Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21866the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21867performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21868
21869
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218708.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21871---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021872
21873Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21874achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021875section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021876cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21877the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21878the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021879locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021880not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21881user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21882a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21883wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21884
21885 Examples :
21886 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21887 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21888
21889 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21890 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21891
21892
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218938.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21894---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021895
21896Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21897proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21898the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21899server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21900
21901Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21902response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021903section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021904
21905It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021906time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21907appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021908are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21909and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21910follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21911request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21912in the logs.
21913
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021914As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21915frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21916an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21917
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021918 Example :
21919 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21920 listen proxy-out
21921 mode http
21922 option httplog
21923 option logasap
21924 log global
21925 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21926
21927 # log the name of the virtual server
21928 capture request header Host len 20
21929
21930 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21931 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21932
21933 # log the beginning of the referrer
21934 capture request header Referer len 20
21935
21936 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21937 capture response header Server len 20
21938
21939 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21940 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21941
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021942 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021943 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21944
21945 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21946 capture response header Via len 20
21947
21948 # log the URL location during a redirection
21949 capture response header Location len 20
21950
21951 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21952 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21953 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21954 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21955 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21956
21957 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21958 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21959 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21960 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021961 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021962
21963 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21964 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21965 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21966 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21967 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021968 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021969
21970
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219718.9. Examples of logs
21972---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021973
21974These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21975them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21976reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21977
21978 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21979 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21980 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21981
21982 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21983 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21984
21985 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21986 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21987 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21988
21989 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21990 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21991
21992 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21993 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21994 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21995
21996 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021997 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021998 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21999 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
22000
22001 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
22002 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
22003 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
22004
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020022005 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
22006 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
22007 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
22008 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022009 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020022010 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022011
22012 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022013 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022014
22015 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
22016 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
22017 Nothing was sent to any server.
22018
22019 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
22020 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
22021
22022 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
22023 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022024 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022025 send a 408 return code to the client.
22026
22027 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
22028 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
22029
22030 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
22031 5 seconds ("c----").
22032
22033 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
22034 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022035 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022036
22037 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022038 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022039 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
22040 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
22041 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
22042 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
22043 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010022044
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020022045
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200220469. Supported filters
22047--------------------
22048
22049Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
22050accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
22051unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
22052
22053See also : "filter"
22054
220559.1. Trace
22056----------
22057
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010022058filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022059
22060 Arguments:
22061 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
22062 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
22063
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010022064 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022065
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022066 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022067 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
22068 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
22069 amount of the parsed data.
22070
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022071 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010022072
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022073This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
22074callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
22075information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
22076filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
22077
22078Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
22079tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
22080a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
22081
22082
220839.2. HTTP compression
22084---------------------
22085
22086filter compression
22087
22088The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
22089keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022090when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
22091fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
22092done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
22093explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
22094filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
22095listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22096order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022097
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022098See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
22099 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022100
22101
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200221029.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
22103--------------------------------------------
22104
22105filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
22106
22107 Arguments :
22108
22109 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
22110 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
22111 parsed.
22112
22113 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
22114 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
22115 part must be placed in its own scope.
22116
22117The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
22118external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022119streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020022120exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
22121also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
22122
22123SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
22124the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
22125
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010022126For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020022127"doc/SPOE.txt".
22128
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100221299.4. Cache
22130----------
22131
22132filter cache <name>
22133
22134 Arguments :
22135
22136 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
22137
22138The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
22139"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050022140cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022141other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
22142case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
22143is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
22144filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010022145listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22146order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010022147
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022148See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
22149 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
22150
22151
221529.5. Fcgi-app
22153-------------
22154
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040022155filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022156
22157 Arguments :
22158
22159 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
22160
22161The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
22162request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
22163reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
22164used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
22165implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
22166used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
22167fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
22168used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22169order.
22170
22171See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
22172 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
22173
22174
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100221759.6. OpenTracing
22176----------------
22177
22178The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
22179HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
22180of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
22181Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
22182
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022183This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022184
22185The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
22186HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
22187participates in the work of HAProxy.
22188
22189filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
22190
22191 Arguments :
22192
22193 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
22194 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
22195 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
22196 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
22197 OpenTracing filters.
22198
22199 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
22200 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
22201 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
22202 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
22203 filter must have its own scope defined.
22204
22205More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020022206of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022207
22208
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002220910. FastCGI applications
22210-------------------------
22211
22212HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
22213feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
22214the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
22215FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
22216servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
22217FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
22218backend.
22219
22220HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
22221application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
22222connection.
22223
2222410.1. Setup
22225-----------
22226
2222710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
22228--------------------------
22229
22230fcgi-app <name>
22231 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
22232 document root must be defined.
22233
22234acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
22235 Declare or complete an access list.
22236
22237 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
22238 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
22239 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
22240 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
22241 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
22242
22243docroot <path>
22244 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
22245 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
22246 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
22247
22248index <script-name>
22249 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
22250 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
22251 is an optional setting.
22252
22253 Example :
22254 index index.php
22255
22256log-stderr global
22257log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010022258 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022259 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
22260
22261 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
22262 default STDERR messages are ignored.
22263
22264pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22265 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
22266 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
22267 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22268
22269 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
22270 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
22271 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
22272 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
22273
22274 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
22275 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
22276
22277path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022278 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022279 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
22280 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
22281 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
22282 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
22283 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
22284 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
22285 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022286
22287 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022288 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022289 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
22290 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
22291 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
22292 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022293
22294 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022295 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
22296 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022297
22298option get-values
22299no option get-values
22300 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
22301
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040022302 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022303 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
22304
22305 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
22306 application will accept.
22307
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020022308 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
22309 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022310
22311 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050022312 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022313 option is disabled.
22314
22315 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
22316 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
22317 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
22318 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
22319 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
22320 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
22321
22322option keep-conn
22323no option keep-conn
22324 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
22325 sending a response.
22326
22327 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
22328 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
22329
22330option max-reqs <reqs>
22331 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
22332 accept.
22333
22334 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
22335 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
22336 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
22337 to 1.
22338
22339option mpxs-conns
22340no option mpxs-conns
22341 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
22342
22343 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
22344 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
22345
22346set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22347 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
22348 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
22349 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
22350 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22351
22352 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
22353 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
22354 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
22355
22356 Example :
22357 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
22358 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
22359
22360 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
22361
22362
2236310.1.2. Proxy section
22364---------------------
22365
22366use-fcgi-app <name>
22367 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
22368
22369 Arguments :
22370 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
22371
22372 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
22373 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
22374 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
22375 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
22376 application may be defined at a time per backend.
22377
22378 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
22379 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
22380 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
22381 application are evaluated.
22382
22383
2238410.1.3. Example
22385---------------
22386
22387 frontend front-http
22388 mode http
22389 bind *:80
22390 bind *:
22391
22392 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
22393 default_backend back-static
22394
22395 backend back-static
22396 mode http
22397 server www A.B.C.D:80
22398
22399 backend back-dynamic
22400 mode http
22401 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
22402 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
22403
22404 fcgi-app php-fpm
22405 log-stderr global
22406 option keep-conn
22407
22408 docroot /var/www/my-app
22409 index index.php
22410 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
22411
22412
2241310.2. Default parameters
22414------------------------
22415
22416A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
22417the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022418script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022419applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
22420
22421 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22422 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
22423 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
22424 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
22425 | | |
22426 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22427 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
22428 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
22429 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
22430 | | application. |
22431 | | |
22432 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22433 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
22434 | | the request. It may not be set. |
22435 | | |
22436 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22437 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
22438 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
22439 | | the application's configuration. |
22440 | | |
22441 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22442 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
22443 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
22444 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
22445 | | |
22446 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22447 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
22448 | | following the part that identifies the script |
22449 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
22450 | | be defined. |
22451 | | |
22452 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22453 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
22454 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
22455 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
22456 | | is not set too. |
22457 | | |
22458 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22459 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
22460 | | set. |
22461 | | |
22462 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22463 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
22464 | | the request. |
22465 | | |
22466 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22467 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
22468 | | client as part of user authentication. |
22469 | | |
22470 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22471 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
22472 | | script to process the request. |
22473 | | |
22474 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22475 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
22476 | | |
22477 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22478 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
22479 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
22480 | | |
22481 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22482 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
22483 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
22484 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
22485 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
22486 | | |
22487 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22488 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
22489 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
22490 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
22491 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
22492 | | side. |
22493 | | |
22494 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22495 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
22496 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
22497 | | connected to. |
22498 | | |
22499 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22500 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
22501 | | |
22502 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020022503 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
22504 | | current HAProxy version. |
22505 | | |
22506 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022507 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22508 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22509 | | |
22510 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22511
22512
2251310.3. Limitations
22514------------------
22515
22516The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
22517way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
22518during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
22519establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
22520application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
22521or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
22522message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
22523these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
22524and HTTP servers under the same backend.
22525
22526Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
22527request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
22528requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
22529
22530About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
22531into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
22532fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
22533"http-request" ones.
22534
22535Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
22536FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
22537processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
22538must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
22539here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010022540
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022541
2254211. Address formats
22543-------------------
22544
22545Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
22546address.
22547
22548This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
22549The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
22550of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
22551equivalent is '::'.
22552
22553Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
22554is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
22555
22556This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
22557family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
22558
22559Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
22560configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
22561use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
22562'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
22563
22564Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
22565socket type and the transport method.
22566
22567
2256811.1 Address family prefixes
22569----------------------------
22570
22571'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
22572
22573'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
22574 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
22575 listening.
22576
22577'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
22578 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
22579 on the statement using this address, a port or
22580 a port range may or must be specified.
22581
22582'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22583 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
22584 using this address, a port or a port range
22585 may or must be specified.
22586
22587'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22588 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22589 using this address, a port or a port range
22590 may or must be specified.
22591
22592'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22593 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22594 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22595 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22596 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22597 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22598
22599'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22600 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22601 start by slash '/'.
22602
22603
2260411.2 Socket type prefixes
22605-------------------------
22606
22607Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22608type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22609this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22610This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22611but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22612
22613Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
22614instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
22615
22616If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22617they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22618report this to the maintainers.
22619
22620'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22621 to "stream"
22622
22623'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22624 to "datagram".
22625
22626
2262711.3 Protocol prefixes
22628----------------------
22629
22630'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22631 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22632 socket type and transport method is forced to
22633 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22634 this address, a port or a port range can or
22635 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22636 of 'stream+ip@'.
22637
22638'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22639 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22640 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22641 statement using this address, a port or port
22642 range can or must be specified.
22643 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22644
22645'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22646 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22647 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22648 statement using this address, a port or port
22649 range can or must be specified.
22650 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22651
22652'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22653 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22654 socket type and transport method is forced to
22655 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22656 this address, a port or a port range can or
22657 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22658 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22659
22660'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22661 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22662 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22663 the statement using this address, a port or
22664 port range can or must be specified.
22665 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22666
22667'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22668 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22669 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22670 the statement using this address, a port or
22671 port range can or must be specified.
22672 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22673
22674'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22675 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22676 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22677
22678'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22679 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22680 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22681
22682In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22683QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22684
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022685/*
22686 * Local variables:
22687 * fill-column: 79
22688 * End:
22689 */